blob: 54555aaf3ee0ab66025c0d38349fa595e4096c23 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau991b4782015-10-13 21:48:10 +02005 version 1.7
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau608efa12016-10-25 22:22:00 +02007 2016/10/25
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200595. Bind and Server options
605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001069. Supported filters
1079.1. Trace
1089.2. HTTP compression
109
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200110
1111. Quick reminder about HTTP
112----------------------------
113
114When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
115fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
116on almost anything found in the contents.
117
118However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
119formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
120correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
121
122
1231.1. The HTTP transaction model
124-------------------------------
125
126The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100127to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
129connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
130will involve a new connection :
131
132 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
133
134In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
135establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
136by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
137length.
138
139Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
140to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
141however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
142response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
143header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
144
145 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
146
147Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
148power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
149but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200150a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200151
152A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
153keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
154second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
155page :
156
157 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
158
159This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
160latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
161correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
162the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100163server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100165By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
166connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
167leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
168start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200169
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100170HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
171 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
172 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
173 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
174 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
175 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
176 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
177
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178
1791.2. HTTP request
180-----------------
181
182First, let's consider this HTTP request :
183
184 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100185 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200186 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
187 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
188 3 User-agent: my small browser
189 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
190 5 Accept: image/png
191
192
1931.2.1. The Request line
194-----------------------
195
196Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
197
198 - a METHOD : GET
199 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
200 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
201
202All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
203which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
204followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
205is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
206desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
207the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
208
209The URI itself can have several forms :
210
211 - A "relative URI" :
212
213 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
214
215 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
216 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
217
218 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
219
220 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
221
222 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
223 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
224 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
225 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
226 must accept this form too.
227
228 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
229 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
230 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100231
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200232 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
233 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
234 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
235 other protocols too.
236
237In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
238mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
239on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
240It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
241specific to the language, framework or application in use.
242
243
2441.2.2. The request headers
245--------------------------
246
247The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
248beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
249an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
250Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
251values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
252encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
253the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
254define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
255
256Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
257their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
258"Connection:" header).
259
260The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
261that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
262is one valid form of empty line.
263
264Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
265headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
266about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
267application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
268
269Important note:
270 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
271 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
272 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
273 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
274
275
2761.3. HTTP response
277------------------
278
279An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
280messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
281
282 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100283 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200284 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
285 2 Content-length: 350
286 3 Content-Type: text/html
287
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200288As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
289codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
290response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100291continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
292the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
293following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
294sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
295(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
296correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
297such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
298state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
299over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
300if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
301information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200302
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200303
3041.3.1. The Response line
305------------------------
306
307Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
308
309 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
310 - a status code : 200
311 - a reason : OK
312
313The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200314 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200315 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
316 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
317 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
318 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
319
320Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100321"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200322found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
323messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
324or "Authentication Required".
325
326Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
327
328 Code When / reason
329 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
330 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
331 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
332 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100333 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
334 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200335 400 for an invalid or too large request
336 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
337 accessing the stats page)
338 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
339 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
340 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
341 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
342 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
343 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
344 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
345 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
346 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
347
348The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3494.2).
350
351
3521.3.2. The response headers
353---------------------------
354
355Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
356the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
357details.
358
359
3602. Configuring HAProxy
361----------------------
362
3632.1. Configuration file format
364------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200365
366HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
367
368 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
369 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
370 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
371 "frontend" and "backend".
372
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100373The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
374referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200375delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100376
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200377
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02003782.2. Quoting and escaping
379-------------------------
380
381HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
382many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
383with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
384single quotes.
385
386If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
387them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
388escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
389
390Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
391
392 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
393 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
394 \\ to use a backslash
395 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
396 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
397
398Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
399the interpretation of:
400
401 space as a parameter separator
402 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
403 # hash as a comment start
404
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200405Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
406-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
407backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
408
409Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200410quoting.
411
412Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
413nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
414
415Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
416equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
417
418 Example:
419 # those are equivalents:
420 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
421 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
422 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
423 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
424 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
425
426 # those are equivalents:
427 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
428 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
429 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
430 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
431
432
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004332.3. Environment variables
434--------------------------
435
436HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
437interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
438configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
439optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
440shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
441underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
442
443 Example:
444
445 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
446
447 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
448
449 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
450
451
4522.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200453----------------
454
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100455Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100456values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
457otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
458numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
459for every keyword. Supported units are :
460
461 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
462 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
463 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
464 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
465 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
466 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
467
468
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004692.4. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200470-------------
471
472 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
473 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
474 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
475 global
476 daemon
477 maxconn 256
478
479 defaults
480 mode http
481 timeout connect 5000ms
482 timeout client 50000ms
483 timeout server 50000ms
484
485 frontend http-in
486 bind *:80
487 default_backend servers
488
489 backend servers
490 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
491
492
493 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
494 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
495 global
496 daemon
497 maxconn 256
498
499 defaults
500 mode http
501 timeout connect 5000ms
502 timeout client 50000ms
503 timeout server 50000ms
504
505 listen http-in
506 bind *:80
507 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
508
509
510Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
511
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100512 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200513
514
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005153. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200516--------------------
517
518Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
519are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
520of them have command-line equivalents.
521
522The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
523
524 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200525 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200526 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200527 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200528 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200529 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200530 - description
531 - deviceatlas-json-file
532 - deviceatlas-log-level
533 - deviceatlas-separator
534 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900535 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200536 - gid
537 - group
538 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200539 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100540 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200541 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200542 - nbproc
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200543 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200544 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100545 - presetenv
546 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200547 - uid
548 - ulimit-n
549 - user
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100550 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200551 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200552 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
553 - ssl-default-bind-options
554 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
555 - ssl-default-server-options
556 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100557 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100558 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100559 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100560 - 51degrees-data-file
561 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200562 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200563 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100564
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200565 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200566 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200567 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200568 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100569 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100570 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100571 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200572 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200573 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200574 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200575 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200576 - noepoll
577 - nokqueue
578 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100579 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300580 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000581 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200582 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200583 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200584 - server-state-file
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200585 - tune.buffers.limit
586 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200587 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200588 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100589 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100590 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200591 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100592 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100593 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100594 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100595 - tune.lua.session-timeout
596 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200597 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100598 - tune.maxaccept
599 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200600 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200601 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200602 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100603 - tune.rcvbuf.client
604 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100605 - tune.recv_enough
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100606 - tune.sndbuf.client
607 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100608 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100609 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200610 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100611 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200612 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200613 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200614 - tune.vars.global-max-size
615 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
616 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
617 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100618 - tune.zlib.memlevel
619 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100620
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200621 * Debugging
622 - debug
623 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200624
625
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006263.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200627------------------------------------
628
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200629ca-base <dir>
630 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200631 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
632 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200633
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200634chroot <jail dir>
635 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
636 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
637 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
638 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
639 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
640 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100641
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100642cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
643 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
644 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
645 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100646 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
647 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
648 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
649 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
650 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
651 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
652 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
653 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
654 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
655 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100656
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200657crt-base <dir>
658 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
659 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
660 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
661
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200662daemon
663 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
664 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
665 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
666
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200667deviceatlas-json-file <path>
668 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
669 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by Haproxy process.
670
671deviceatlas-log-level <value>
672 Sets the level of informations returned by the API. This directive is
673 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
674
675deviceatlas-separator <char>
676 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
677 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
678
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100679deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200680 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
681 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
682 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100683
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900684external-check
685 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
686 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
687 See "option external-check".
688
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200689gid <number>
690 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
691 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
692 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100693 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
694 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200695 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100696
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200697group <group name>
698 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
699 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100700
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200701log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200702 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
703 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100704 configured with "log global".
705
706 <address> can be one of:
707
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100708 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100709 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
710 port).
711
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100712 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
713 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
714 port).
715
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100716 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
717 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
718 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
719 writeable).
720
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200721 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
722 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100723
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200724 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
725 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
726 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
727 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
728 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
729 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
730 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
731 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
732 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
733 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
734 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
735
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200736 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
737 one of the following :
738
739 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
740 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
741
742 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
743 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
744
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100745 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200746
747 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
748 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
749 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
750
751 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200752 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
753 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
754 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
755 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
756 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
757 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200758
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200759 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200760
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100761log-send-hostname [<string>]
762 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
763 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
764 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
765 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
766 the logs.
767
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000768log-tag <string>
769 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
770 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
771 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100772 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000773
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100774lua-load <file>
775 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
776 used multiple times.
777
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200778nbproc <number>
779 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
780 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
781 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
782 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
783 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
784
785pidfile <pidfile>
786 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
787 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
788 starting the process. See also "daemon".
789
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100790presetenv <name> <value>
791 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
792 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
793 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
794 and "unsetenv".
795
796resetenv [<name> ...]
797 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
798 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
799 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
800 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
801 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
802 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
803 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
804 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
805
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100806stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200807 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
808 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
809 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
810 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
811 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
812 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100813 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200814 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
815 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200816
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200817server-state-base <directory>
818 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200819 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
820 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200821
822server-state-file <file>
823 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
824 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
825 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
826 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
827 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
828 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
829 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
830 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200831 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
832 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200833
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100834setenv <name> <value>
835 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
836 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
837 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
838 and "unsetenv".
839
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100840ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
841 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
842 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300843 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100844 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
845 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
846 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
847 "bind" keyword for more information.
848
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100849ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
850 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
851 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
852 keyword to see available options.
853
854 Example:
855 global
856 ssl-default-bind-options no-sslv3 no-tls-tickets
857
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100858ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
859 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
860 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300861 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100862 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
863 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
864 information.
865
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100866ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
867 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
868 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
869 keyword to see available options.
870
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200871ssl-dh-param-file <file>
872 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
873 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
874 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
875 which do not explicitely define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
876 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200877 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
878 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
879 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
880 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200881 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
882 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
883 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
884
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100885ssl-server-verify [none|required]
886 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
887 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
888 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
889
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200890stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
891 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
892 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
893 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +0200894 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
895 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200896
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200897 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
898 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
899 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200900
901stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
902 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
903 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100904 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200905
906stats maxconn <connections>
907 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
908 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
909
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200910uid <number>
911 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
912 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
913 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
914 one. See also "gid" and "user".
915
916ulimit-n <number>
917 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
918 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
919 option.
920
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100921unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
922 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
923
924 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
925 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
926 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
927 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
928 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
929 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
930 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
931 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
932 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
933 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
934
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100935unsetenv [<name> ...]
936 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
937 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
938 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
939 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
940 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
941 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
942 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
943
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200944user <user name>
945 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
946 See also "uid" and "group".
947
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200948node <name>
949 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
950
951 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
952 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
953 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
954 traffic.
955
956description <text>
957 Add a text that describes the instance.
958
959 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
960 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
961 "<" and ">" characters.
962
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +010096351degrees-data-file <file path>
964 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
965 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevavnt permissions.
966
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200967 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100968 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
969
97051degrees-property-name-list [<string>]
971 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
972 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
973 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
974
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200975 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100976 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
977
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +020097851degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100979 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
980 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
981
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200982 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
983 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
984
98551degrees-cache-size <number>
986 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
987 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
988 By default, this cache is disabled.
989
990 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100991 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
992
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200993
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009943.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200995-----------------------
996
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200997max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
998 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
999 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1000 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1001 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1002 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1003 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1004 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1005 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1006
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001007maxconn <number>
1008 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1009 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1010 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001011 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1012 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1013 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1014 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001015 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
1016 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
1017 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
1018 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
1019 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001020
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001021maxconnrate <number>
1022 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1023 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1024 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1025 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1026 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1027 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1028 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1029 fairness.
1030
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001031maxcomprate <number>
1032 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001033 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001034 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1035 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1036 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
1037 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
1038 default value.
1039
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001040maxcompcpuusage <number>
1041 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1042 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1043 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1044 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1045 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1046 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1047 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1048 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1049
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001050maxpipes <number>
1051 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1052 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1053 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1054 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1055 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1056 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1057
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001058maxsessrate <number>
1059 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1060 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1061 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1062 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1063 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1064 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1065 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1066 fairness.
1067
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001068maxsslconn <number>
1069 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1070 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1071 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1072 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1073 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1074 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1075 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001076 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1077 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1078 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1079 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1080 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1081 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1082 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001083
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001084maxsslrate <number>
1085 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1086 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1087 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1088 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1089 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1090 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1091 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1092 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1093 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1094 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1095
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001096maxzlibmem <number>
1097 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1098 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1099 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001100 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1101 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1102 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1103
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001104noepoll
1105 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1106 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001107 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001108
1109nokqueue
1110 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1111 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1112 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1113
1114nopoll
1115 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1116 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001117 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001118 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001119
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001120nosplice
1121 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
1122 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
1123 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001124 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001125 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1126 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1127 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1128 "option splice-response".
1129
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001130nogetaddrinfo
1131 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1132 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1133
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001134noreuseport
1135 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1136 command line argument "-dR".
1137
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001138spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001139 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1140 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1141 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1142 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1143 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1144 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001145
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001146tune.buffers.limit <number>
1147 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1148 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1149 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1150 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1151 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
1152 behaviour. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
1153 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1154 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1155 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1156 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1157 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1158 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1159 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1160 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1161 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1162
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001163tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1164 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1165 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1166 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1167 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1168
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001169tune.bufsize <number>
1170 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1171 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1172 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1173 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1174 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1175 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1176 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
1177 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001178 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
1179 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
1180 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001181
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001182tune.chksize <number>
1183 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1184 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1185 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1186 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1187 checks whenever possible.
1188
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001189tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1190 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1191 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1192 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1193 this value. The default value is 1.
1194
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001195tune.http.cookielen <number>
1196 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1197 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1198 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1199 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1200 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1201 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1202 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1203 to change this value.
1204
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001205tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1206 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1207 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1208 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1209 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1210 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1211 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
1212 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
1213 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
1214 limit too high.
1215
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001216tune.idletimer <timeout>
1217 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1218 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1219 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1220 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1221 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1222 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
1223 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
1224 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1225 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1226
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001227tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1228 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
1229 instructions executed. This permits interruptng a long script and allows the
1230 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1231 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
1232 executes some Lua code but more reactivity is required, this value can be
1233 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1234 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1235
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001236tune.lua.maxmem
1237 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1238 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1239 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1240 memory.
1241
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001242tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1243 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001244 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1245 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1246 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001247
1248tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1249 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1250 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1251 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1252 check servers.
1253
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001254tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1255 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1256 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1257 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1258 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
1259
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001260tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001261 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1262 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1263 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1264 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1265 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1266 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1267 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1268 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1269 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1270 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001271
1272tune.maxpollevents <number>
1273 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1274 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1275 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1276 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1277 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1278
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001279tune.maxrewrite <number>
1280 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1281 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1282 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1283 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1284 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1285 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1286 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1287 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1288 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1289 bufsize.
1290
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001291tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1292 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1293 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1294 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1295 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1296 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1297 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1298 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1299 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1300 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1301 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1302 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1303 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1304 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1305 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1306 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1307 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1308 setting this parameter to 0.
1309
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001310tune.pipesize <number>
1311 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1312 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1313 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1314 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1315 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1316 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1317
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001318tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1319tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1320 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1321 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1322 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1323 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1324 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1325 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1326 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1327
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001328tune.recv_enough <number>
1329 Haproxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
1330 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1331 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1332 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1333 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1334
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001335tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1336tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1337 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1338 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1339 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1340 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1341 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1342 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1343 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1344 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1345 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1346 notifying haproxy again.
1347
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001348tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001349 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1350 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1351 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001352 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001353 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1354 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1355 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1356 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1357 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001358 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1359 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001360
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001361tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1362 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1363 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1364 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1365 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1366 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1367 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1368
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001369tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1370 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001371 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001372 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1373 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1374 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1375 being used for too long.
1376
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001377tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1378 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1379 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1380 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1381 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1382 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1383 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1384 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1385 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1386 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1387 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001388 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1389 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001390
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001391tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1392 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1393 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1394 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1395 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1396 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1397 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1398 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001399 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1400 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001401
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001402tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1403 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1404 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1405 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1406 1000 entries.
1407
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001408tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
1409tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1410tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1411tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001412 These four tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1413 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available
1414 for all scopes. "sess" limits the memory for the session scope, "txn" for
1415 the transaction scope, and "reqres" limits the memory for each request or
1416 response processing.
1417 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits
1418 include the finer grained ones: "sess" includes "txn", and "txn" includes
1419 "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001420
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001421 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1422 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1423 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1424 all available space is consumed.
1425 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1426 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1427 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001428
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001429tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1430 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001431 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001432 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1433 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1434 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1435
1436tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1437 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1438 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1439 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1440 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001441
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014423.3. Debugging
1443--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001444
1445debug
1446 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1447 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1448 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1449 system startup.
1450
1451quiet
1452 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1453 line argument "-q".
1454
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001455
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010014563.4. Userlists
1457--------------
1458It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1459http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1460it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1461
1462userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001463 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001464 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1465
1466group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001467 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001468 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1469 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1470
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001471user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1472 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001473 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1474 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001475 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1476 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001477 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001478 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001479
1480
1481 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001482 userlist L1
1483 group G1 users tiger,scott
1484 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001485
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001486 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1487 user scott insecure-password elgato
1488 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001489
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001490 userlist L2
1491 group G1
1492 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001493
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001494 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1495 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1496 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001497
1498 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001499
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001500
15013.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001502----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001503It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1504several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1505instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1506values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1507automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1508In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1509using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1510tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1511reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1512Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1513that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1514each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001515
1516peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001517 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001518 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1519
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001520disabled
1521 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1522 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1523 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1524
1525enable
1526 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1527
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001528peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1529 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1530 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1531 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1532 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1533 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1534 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1535
1536 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1537 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1538
1539 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1540 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1541 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1542 across all peers.
1543
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001544 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1545 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001546
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001547 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001548 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001549 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1550 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1551 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001552
1553 backend mybackend
1554 mode tcp
1555 balance roundrobin
1556 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1557 stick on src
1558
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001559 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1560 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001561
1562
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090015633.6. Mailers
1564------------
1565It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1566If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1567in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1568
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02001569mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001570 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1571 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1572
1573mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1574 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1575
1576 Example:
1577 mailers mymailers
1578 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1579 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1580
1581 backend mybackend
1582 mode tcp
1583 balance roundrobin
1584
1585 email-alert mailers mymailers
1586 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1587 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1588
1589 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1590 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1591
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01001592timeout mail <time>
1593 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
1594 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
1595 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
1596 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
1597
1598 Example:
1599 mailers mymailers
1600 timeout mail 20s
1601 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001602
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016034. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001604----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001605
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001606Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02001607 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001608 - frontend <name>
1609 - backend <name>
1610 - listen <name>
1611
1612A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1613its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1614section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001615section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001616
1617A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1618connections.
1619
1620A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1621to forward incoming connections.
1622
1623A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1624parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1625
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001626All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1627'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1628case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1629
1630Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1631logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1632proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1633However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1634name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1635
1636Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1637and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001638bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001639protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1640modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1641arbitrary criteria.
1642
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001643In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1644a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1645the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1646
1647 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1648 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1649 between responses and new requests.
1650
1651 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1652 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1653 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1654 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1655
1656 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1657 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1658 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1659
1660 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1661 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1662 client-facing connection remains open.
1663
1664 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1665 after the end of the response.
1666
1667The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1668frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1669following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1670weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1671
1672 Backend mode
1673
1674 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1675 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1676 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1677 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1678 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1679 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1680 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1681 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1682 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1683 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1684 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1685
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001686
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001687
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016884.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1689--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001690
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001691The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1692limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1693they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1694limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001695marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001696option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001697and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1698with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1699specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001700
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001701
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001702 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1703------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1704acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02001705appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001706backlog X X X -
1707balance X - X X
1708bind - X X -
1709bind-process X X X X
1710block - X X X
1711capture cookie - X X -
1712capture request header - X X -
1713capture response header - X X -
1714clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001715compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001716contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1717cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02001718declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001719default-server X - X X
1720default_backend X X X -
1721description - X X X
1722disabled X X X X
1723dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001724email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09001725email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001726email-alert mailers X X X X
1727email-alert myhostname X X X X
1728email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001729enabled X X X X
1730errorfile X X X X
1731errorloc X X X X
1732errorloc302 X X X X
1733-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1734errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001735force-persist - X X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001736filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001737fullconn X - X X
1738grace X X X X
1739hash-type X - X X
1740http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001741http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001742http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001743http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001744http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02001745http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001746http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001747id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001748ignore-persist - X X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001749load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001750log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001751log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001752log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001753log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001754max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001755maxconn X X X -
1756mode X X X X
1757monitor fail - X X -
1758monitor-net X X X -
1759monitor-uri X X X -
1760option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1761option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1762option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1763option allbackups (*) X - X X
1764option checkcache (*) X - X X
1765option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1766option contstats (*) X X X -
1767option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1768option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1769option forceclose (*) X X X X
1770-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1771option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02001772option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02001773option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001774option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001775option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001776option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001777option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001778option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001779option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1780option httpchk X - X X
1781option httpclose (*) X X X X
1782option httplog X X X X
1783option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001784option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001785option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001786option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001787option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1788option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1789option logasap (*) X X X -
1790option mysql-check X - X X
1791option nolinger (*) X X X X
1792option originalto X X X X
1793option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02001794option pgsql-check X - X X
1795option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001796option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001797option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001798option smtpchk X - X X
1799option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1800option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1801option splice-request (*) X X X X
1802option splice-response (*) X X X X
1803option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1804option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1805-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001806option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001807option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1808option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1809option tcpka X X X X
1810option tcplog X X X X
1811option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001812external-check command X - X X
1813external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001814persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1815rate-limit sessions X X X -
1816redirect - X X X
1817redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1818redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1819reqadd - X X X
1820reqallow - X X X
1821reqdel - X X X
1822reqdeny - X X X
1823reqiallow - X X X
1824reqidel - X X X
1825reqideny - X X X
1826reqipass - X X X
1827reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001828reqitarpit - X X X
1829reqpass - X X X
1830reqrep - X X X
1831-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001832reqtarpit - X X X
1833retries X - X X
1834rspadd - X X X
1835rspdel - X X X
1836rspdeny - X X X
1837rspidel - X X X
1838rspideny - X X X
1839rspirep - X X X
1840rsprep - X X X
1841server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001842server-state-file-name X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001843source X - X X
1844srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02001845stats admin - X X X
1846stats auth X X X X
1847stats enable X X X X
1848stats hide-version X X X X
1849stats http-request - X X X
1850stats realm X X X X
1851stats refresh X X X X
1852stats scope X X X X
1853stats show-desc X X X X
1854stats show-legends X X X X
1855stats show-node X X X X
1856stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001857-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1858stick match - - X X
1859stick on - - X X
1860stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001861stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001862stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001863tcp-check connect - - X X
1864tcp-check expect - - X X
1865tcp-check send - - X X
1866tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001867tcp-request connection - X X -
1868tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001869tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02001870tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001871tcp-response content - - X X
1872tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001873timeout check X - X X
1874timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001875timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001876timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1877timeout connect X - X X
1878timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1879timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1880timeout http-request X X X X
1881timeout queue X - X X
1882timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001883timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001884timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1885timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001886timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001887transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001888unique-id-format X X X -
1889unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001890use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001891use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001892------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1893 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001894
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001895
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018964.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1897---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001898
1899This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1900
1901
1902acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1903 Declare or complete an access list.
1904 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1905 no | yes | yes | yes
1906 Example:
1907 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1908 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1909 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1910
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001911 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001912
1913
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001914appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1915 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001916 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1917 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1918 no | no | yes | yes
1919 Arguments :
1920 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1921 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1922
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001923 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001924 checked in each cookie value.
1925
1926 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1927 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1928 milliseconds.
1929
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001930 request-learn
1931 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1932 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1933 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1934 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1935 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1936 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1937
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001938 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1939 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1940 data following this prefix.
1941
1942 Example :
1943 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1944
1945 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1946 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1947
1948 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1949 2 modes are currently supported :
1950 - path-parameters :
1951 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1952 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1953 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1954 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1955 - query-string :
1956 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1957 query string.
1958
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02001959 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
1960 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
1961 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001962
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001963 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1964 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001965
1966
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001967backlog <conns>
1968 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1969 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1970 yes | yes | yes | no
1971 Arguments :
1972 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1973 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001974 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001975
1976 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1977 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1978 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1979 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1980 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1981 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1982 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1983 backlog parameter.
1984
1985 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1986 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1987 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1988
1989 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1990
1991
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001992balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001993balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001994 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1995 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1996 yes | no | yes | yes
1997 Arguments :
1998 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1999 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2000 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2001 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2002
2003 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2004 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2005 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2006 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002007 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002008 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002009 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2010 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2011 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2012 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2013 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2014 it, so that you don't worry.
2015
2016 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2017 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2018 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2019 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2020 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2021 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2022 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2023 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002024
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002025 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2026 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2027 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2028 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2029 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2030 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2031 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2032 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2033
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002034 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002035 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002036 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2037 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002038 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002039 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2040 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2041 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2042 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2043 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002044 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2045 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2046 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2047 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2048 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2049 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002050
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002051 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2052 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2053 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2054 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2055 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2056 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2057 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2058 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002059 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002060 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002061 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2062 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2063 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002064
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002065 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2066 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2067 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2068 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2069 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2070 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2071 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2072 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2073 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2074 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2075 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2076 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002077
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002078 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002079 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2080 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2081 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2082 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2083 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2084 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2085 URIs start with a leading "/".
2086
2087 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2088 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2089 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2090 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2091
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002092 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002093 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2094
2095 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002096 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2097 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002098 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2099 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2100 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2101 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002102 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002103 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2104 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002105
2106 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2107 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2108 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2109 server will receive the request.
2110
2111 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2112 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2113 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2114 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2115 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002116 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2117 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2118 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002119
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002120 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2121 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2122 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2123 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2124 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002125
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002126 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002127 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2128 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2129 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2130
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002131 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2132 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2133 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2134
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002135 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002136 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002137 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2138 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2139 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2140 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2141 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2142 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002143 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002144 used instead.
2145
2146 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2147 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2148 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2149 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2150
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002151 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2152 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2153 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2154
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002155 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002156
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002157 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002158 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2159 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002160
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002161 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2162 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2163 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002164
2165 Examples :
2166 balance roundrobin
2167 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002168 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002169 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2170 balance hdr(host)
2171 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002172
2173 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2174 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2175
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002176 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002177 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2178 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2179 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2180 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2181
2182 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2183 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2184 defaults to 16 kB.
2185
2186 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2187 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2188
2189 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2190 Round Robin.
2191
2192 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
2193 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2194 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2195 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2196
2197 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2198
2199 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002200 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002201 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2202 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2203 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002204
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002205 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002206
2207
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002208bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2209bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002210 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2211 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2212 no | yes | yes | no
2213 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002214 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2215 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2216 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2217 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002218 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002219 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2220 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2221 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2222 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2223 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2224 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2225 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002226 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2227 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2228 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2229 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2230 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2231 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2232 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002233 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2234 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2235 be listening.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002236 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2237 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2238 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002239
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002240 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2241 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002242 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2243 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2244 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002245 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2246 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2247 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2248 the range.
2249
2250 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2251 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2252 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2253 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2254 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2255 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2256 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002257 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002258 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002259
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002260 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
2261 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
2262 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2263 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2264 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2265 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2266 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2267 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2268
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002269 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2270 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2271 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2272 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002273
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002274 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2275 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2276 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2277 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2278 in a frontend.
2279
2280 Example :
2281 listen http_proxy
2282 bind :80,:443
2283 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002284 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002285
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002286 listen http_https_proxy
2287 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002288 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002289
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002290 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2291 bind ipv6@:80
2292 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2293 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2294
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002295 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002296 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002297
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002298 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2299 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2300 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2301 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2302 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2303
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002304 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002305 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002306
2307
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002308bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002309 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2310 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2311 yes | yes | yes | yes
2312 Arguments :
2313 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2314 may be used to override a default value.
2315
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002316 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002317 option may be combined with other numbers.
2318
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002319 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002320 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2321 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2322 missing from all processes.
2323
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002324 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002325 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002326 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
2327 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
2328 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
2329 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002330
2331 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2332 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2333 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2334 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2335 and 'even' instances.
2336
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002337 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2338 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2339 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2340 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002341
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002342 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2343 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2344
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002345 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2346 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2347 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2348
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002349 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2350 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2351
2352 Example :
2353 listen app_ip1
2354 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002355 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002356
2357 listen app_ip2
2358 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002359 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002360
2361 listen management
2362 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002363 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002364
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002365 listen management
2366 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2367 bind-process 1-4
2368
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002369 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002370
2371
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002372block { if | unless } <condition>
2373 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2374 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2375 no | yes | yes | yes
2376
2377 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2378 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002379 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002380 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002381 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
2382 "block" statements per instance.
2383
2384 Example:
2385 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2386 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2387 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2388 block if invalid_src || local_dst
2389
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002390 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002391
2392
2393capture cookie <name> len <length>
2394 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2395 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2396 no | yes | yes | no
2397 Arguments :
2398 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2399 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2400 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2401 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
2402 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
2403
2404 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2405 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2406 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2407 right if it exceeds <length>.
2408
2409 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2410 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2411 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2412 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2413
2414 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2415 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2416 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2417
2418 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2419 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2420 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002421 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2422 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2423 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002424
2425 Example:
2426 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2427
2428 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002429 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002430
2431
2432capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002433 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002434 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2435 no | yes | yes | no
2436 Arguments :
2437 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002438 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002439 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2440 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2441 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2442
2443 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2444 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2445 it exceeds <length>.
2446
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002447 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002448 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2449 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002450 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2451 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2452 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2453 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002454 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002455 environments to find where the request came from.
2456
2457 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2458 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2459 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2460 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002461
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002462 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2463 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2464 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2465 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2466 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002467
2468 Example:
2469 capture request header Host len 15
2470 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01002471 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002472
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002473 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002474 about logging.
2475
2476
2477capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002478 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002479 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2480 no | yes | yes | no
2481 Arguments :
2482 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002483 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002484 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2485 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2486 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2487
2488 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2489 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2490 it exceeds <length>.
2491
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002492 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002493 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2494 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2495 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002496 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2497 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2498 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2499 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002500
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002501 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2502 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2503 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2504 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2505 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002506
2507 Example:
2508 capture response header Content-length len 9
2509 capture response header Location len 15
2510
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002511 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002512 about logging.
2513
2514
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002515clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002516 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2517 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2518 yes | yes | yes | no
2519 Arguments :
2520 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2521 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2522 as explained at the top of this document.
2523
2524 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2525 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2526 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2527 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2528 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2529 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2530 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2531 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002532 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002533 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2534 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2535
2536 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2537 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2538 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2539 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2540 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2541 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2542
2543 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2544 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2545
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002546 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2547 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002548
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002549compression algo <algorithm> ...
2550compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002551compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002552 Enable HTTP compression.
2553 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2554 yes | yes | yes | yes
2555 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002556 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2557 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2558 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2559
2560 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002561 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
2562 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2563 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002564
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002565 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002566 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002567
2568 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2569 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
2570 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
2571 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
2572 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002573 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002574
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002575 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
2576 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
2577 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
2578 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
2579 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
2580 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
2581 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002582 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002583
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002584 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002585 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002586 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2587 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2588 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2589 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2590 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002591
2592 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2593 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2594 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2595 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2596 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002597 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2598 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2599 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2600 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2601 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002602 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2603 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002604
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002605 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002606 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2607 "Accept-Encoding" header
2608 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002609 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002610 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2611 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002612 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2613 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2614 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2615 "multipart"
2616 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2617 header
2618 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2619 and later
2620 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2621 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002622
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002623 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2624 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002625
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002626 Examples :
2627 compression algo gzip
2628 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002629
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002630
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002631contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002632 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2633 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2634 yes | no | yes | yes
2635 Arguments :
2636 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2637 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2638 as explained at the top of this document.
2639
2640 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002641 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002642 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002643 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2644 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2645 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2646 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2647
2648 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2649 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2650 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2651 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2652 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2653 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2654
2655 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2656 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2657 instead.
2658
2659 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2660 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2661
2662
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002663cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002664 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2665 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002666 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2667 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2668 yes | no | yes | yes
2669 Arguments :
2670 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2671 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2672 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2673 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2674 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2675 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2676 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2677 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2678 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2679
2680 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2681 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2682 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2683 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2684 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2685 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002686 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
2687 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
2688 behaviour is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
2689 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
2690 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002691
2692 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002693 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002694
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002695 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002696 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2697 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2698 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2699 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2700 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2701 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2702 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2703 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2704 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2705 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002706
2707 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2708 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2709 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2710 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2711 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2712 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2713 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2714 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2715 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002716 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002717 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2718 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2719 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002720
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002721 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2722 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2723 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002724 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2725 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2726 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2727 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002728 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2729 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2730 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002731
2732 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2733 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2734 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2735 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2736 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2737 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2738 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2739 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2740 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2741
2742 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2743 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2744 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2745 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2746 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2747 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2748 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2749 persistence cookie in the cache.
2750 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2751
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002752 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2753 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2754 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2755 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2756 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2757 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2758 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2759 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2760 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2761 they logout.
2762
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002763 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2764 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2765 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2766 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2767
2768 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2769 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2770 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2771 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2772 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2773 this attribute.
2774
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002775 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002776 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002777 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2778 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2779 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2780 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2781 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2782 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002783
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002784 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2785 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2786 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2787 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2788 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2789 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2790 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2791 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2792 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2793 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2794 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2795 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2796 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2797 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2798 the site.
2799
2800 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2801 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2802 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2803 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2804 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2805 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2806 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2807 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2808 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2809 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2810 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2811 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2812 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2813 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2814 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2815 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2816
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002817 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2818 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2819 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2820 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002821
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002822 Examples :
2823 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2824 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2825 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002826 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002827
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002828 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002829
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002830
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002831declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
2832 Declares a capture slot.
2833 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2834 no | yes | yes | no
2835 Arguments:
2836 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
2837
2838 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
2839 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
2840 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
2841 for use in the response.
2842
2843 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02002844 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002845 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
2846
2847
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002848default-server [param*]
2849 Change default options for a server in a backend
2850 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2851 yes | no | yes | yes
2852 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002853 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2854 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2855 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2856 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002857
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002858 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002859 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2860
2861 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002862
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002863
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002864default_backend <backend>
2865 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2866 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2867 yes | yes | yes | no
2868 Arguments :
2869 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2870
2871 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2872 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2873 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2874 will catch all undetermined requests.
2875
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002876 Example :
2877
2878 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2879 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2880 default_backend dynamic
2881
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02002882 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002883
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002884
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002885description <string>
2886 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2887 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2888 no | yes | yes | yes
2889 Arguments : string
2890
2891 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2892 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2893 it describes.
2894 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2895
2896
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002897disabled
2898 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2899 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2900 yes | yes | yes | yes
2901 Arguments : none
2902
2903 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2904 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2905 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2906 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2907 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2908 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2909 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2910
2911 See also : "enabled"
2912
2913
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002914dispatch <address>:<port>
2915 Set a default server address
2916 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2917 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002918 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002919
2920 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2921 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2922 during start-up.
2923
2924 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2925 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2926 possible with normal servers.
2927
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002928 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002929 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2930 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2931 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2932 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2933
2934 See also : "server"
2935
2936
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002937enabled
2938 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2939 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2940 yes | yes | yes | yes
2941 Arguments : none
2942
2943 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2944 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2945
2946 See also : "disabled"
2947
2948
2949errorfile <code> <file>
2950 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2951 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2952 yes | yes | yes | yes
2953 Arguments :
2954 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
CJ Ess108b1dd2015-04-07 12:03:37 -04002955 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
2956 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002957
2958 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002959 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002960 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002961 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2962 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002963
2964 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2965 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2966 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2967
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002968 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2969
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002970 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2971 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2972 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2973 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2974
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002975 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2976 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2977 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2978 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2979 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2980 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2981
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002982 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2983 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2984 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002985 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002986 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2987
2988 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2989
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002990 Example :
2991 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01002992 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002993 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2994 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2995
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002996
2997errorloc <code> <url>
2998errorloc302 <code> <url>
2999 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3000 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3001 yes | yes | yes | yes
3002 Arguments :
3003 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003004 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003005
3006 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3007 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3008 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3009 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3010 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3011
3012 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3013 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3014 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3015
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003016 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3017
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003018 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3019 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3020 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3021 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003022 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003023 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3024 request.
3025
3026 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3027
3028
3029errorloc303 <code> <url>
3030 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3031 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3032 yes | yes | yes | yes
3033 Arguments :
3034 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
3035 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
3036
3037 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3038 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3039 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3040 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3041 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3042
3043 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3044 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3045 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3046
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003047 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3048
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003049 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3050 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3051 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3052 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003053 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003054
3055 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3056
3057
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003058email-alert from <emailaddr>
3059 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
3060 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
3061 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3062 yes | yes | yes | yes
3063
3064 Arguments :
3065
3066 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3067
3068 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3069 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3070
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003071 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003072 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3073 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003074
3075
3076email-alert level <level>
3077 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3078 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3079 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3080 yes | yes | yes | yes
3081
3082 Arguments :
3083
3084 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3085 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3086 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3087
3088 By default level is alert
3089
3090 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3091 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3092 for the proxy.
3093
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003094 Alerts are sent when :
3095
3096 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3097 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3098 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3099 is notice or lower
3100 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3101 and a health check status update occurs
3102
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003103 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3104 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003105 section 3.6 about mailers.
3106
3107
3108email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3109 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3110 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3111 yes | yes | yes | yes
3112
3113 Arguments :
3114
3115 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3116
3117 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3118 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3119
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003120 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3121 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003122
3123
3124email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3125 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3126 mailers.
3127 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3128 yes | yes | yes | yes
3129
3130 Arguments :
3131
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003132 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003133
3134 By default the systems hostname is used.
3135
3136 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3137 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3138 for the proxy.
3139
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003140 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3141 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003142
3143
3144email-alert to <emailaddr>
3145 Declare both the recipent address in the envelope and to address in the
3146 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3147 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3148 yes | yes | yes | yes
3149
3150 Arguments :
3151
3152 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3153
3154 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3155 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3156
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003157 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003158 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3159
3160
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003161force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3162 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3163 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3164 no | yes | yes | yes
3165
3166 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3167 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3168 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3169 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3170 marked down for maintenance operations.
3171
3172 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3173 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3174 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3175 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3176 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3177 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3178 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3179 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3180 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3181
3182 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3183 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3184 is used.
3185
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003186 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003187 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003188
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003189
3190filter <name> [param*]
3191 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3192 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3193 no | yes | yes | yes
3194 Arguments :
3195 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3196 referenced in section 9.
3197
3198 <param*> is a list of parameters accpeted by the filter <name>. The
3199 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
3200 filter. Please refer to the documention of the corresponding
3201 filter (section 9) from all details on the supported parameters.
3202
3203 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3204 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3205
3206 Example:
3207 listen
3208 bind *:80
3209
3210 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3211 filter compression
3212 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3213
3214 compression algo gzip
3215 compression offload
3216
3217 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3218
3219 See also : section 9.
3220
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003221
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003222fullconn <conns>
3223 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3224 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3225 yes | no | yes | yes
3226 Arguments :
3227 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3228 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3229
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003230 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003231 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003232 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003233 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3234 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3235 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3236 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3237 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003238 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003239
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003240 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3241 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003242 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3243 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3244 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003245
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003246 Example :
3247 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3248 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3249 # connections.
3250 backend dynamic
3251 fullconn 10000
3252 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3253 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3254
3255 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3256
3257
3258grace <time>
3259 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3260 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003261 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003262 Arguments :
3263 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3264 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3265 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3266
3267 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3268 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003269 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003270 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3271
3272 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3273 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3274 simplify it.
3275
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003276
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003277hash-balance-factor <factor>
3278 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3279 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3280 yes | no | no | yes
3281 Arguments :
3282 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3283 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
3284 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
3285
3286 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3287 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3288 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3289 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3290 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3291 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3292 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3293
3294 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3295 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3296 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3297 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3298 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3299
3300 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3301
3302
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003303hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003304 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3305 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3306 yes | no | yes | yes
3307 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003308 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3309 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003310
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003311 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3312 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3313 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3314 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3315 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3316 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3317 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3318 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3319 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3320 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003321
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003322 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3323 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3324 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3325 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3326 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3327 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3328 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3329 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3330 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3331 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3332 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3333 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3334 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003335 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3336 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003337
3338 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3339
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003340 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003341 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3342 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3343 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003344 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3345 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3346 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003347
3348 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3349 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003350 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3351 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3352 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3353 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3354
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003355 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3356 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3357 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3358 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3359 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3360 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3361 parameter.
3362
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003363 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3364 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3365 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3366 used on strings.
3367
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003368 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3369
3370 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3371 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3372 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3373 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3374 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3375 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3376 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3377 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3378 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3379 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3380 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3381 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003382
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003383 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3384 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3385 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003386
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003387 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003388
3389
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003390http-check disable-on-404
3391 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3392 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003393 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003394 Arguments : none
3395
3396 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3397 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3398 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3399 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3400 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3401 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3402 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3403 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003404 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3405 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3406 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3407
3408 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3409
3410
3411http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003412 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003413 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003414 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003415 Arguments :
3416 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3417 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003418 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003419 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3420 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3421 details on the supported keywords.
3422
3423 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3424 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3425 with the usual backslash ('\').
3426
3427 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3428 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3429 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3430 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3431 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3432
3433 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003434 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003435 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3436 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3437 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3438
3439 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003440 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003441 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3442 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3443 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3444 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3445
3446 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003447 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003448 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3449 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3450 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3451 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3452 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
3453 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
3454 trace).
3455
3456 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003457 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003458 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3459 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3460 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3461 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3462 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
3463 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
3464
3465 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3466 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3467 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3468 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3469 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3470 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3471 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3472 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3473
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003474 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3475 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3476 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3477
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003478 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3479 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3480
3481 Examples :
3482 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003483 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003484
3485 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003486 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003487
3488 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003489 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003490
3491 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003492 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003493
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003494 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003495
3496
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003497http-check send-state
3498 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3499 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3500 yes | no | yes | yes
3501 Arguments : none
3502
3503 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3504 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3505 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3506 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3507 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3508
3509 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3510 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3511 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3512 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3513 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003514 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3515 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3516 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3517
3518 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3519 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3520 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3521
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003522 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3523 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3524 checked in multiple backends.
3525
3526 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3527 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3528
3529 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3530 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3531 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3532 one fails.
3533
3534 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3535 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3536 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3537
3538 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3539 server's queue.
3540
3541 Example of a header received by the application server :
3542 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3543 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3544
3545 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3546
Willy Tarreaube1d34d2016-06-26 19:37:59 +02003547http-request { allow | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
3548 deny [deny_status <status>] |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003549 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003550 capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003551 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003552 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3553 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003554 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3555 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003556 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3557 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3558 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003559 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003560 set-var(<var name>) <expr> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003561 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003562 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003563 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003564 silent-drop |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003565 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003566 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003567 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3568
3569 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3570 no | yes | yes | yes
3571
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003572 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3573 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3574 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3575 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3576 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003577
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003578 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3579 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3580 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3581
3582 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
Willy Tarreaube1d34d2016-06-26 19:37:59 +02003583 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code
3584 specified as an argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status
3585 codes is limited to those that can be overridden by the "errorfile"
3586 directive. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003587
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003588 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3589 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3590 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
3591 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
3592 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3593 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3594 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3595 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3596 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003597 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003598 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. See
3599 also the "silent-drop" action below.
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003600
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003601 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3602 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3603 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3604 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3605 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3606
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003607 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3608 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3609 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003610 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3611 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003612
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003613 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3614 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3615 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
3616 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
3617 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3618 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3619 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3620 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3621
3622 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3623 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3624 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003625 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3626 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003627
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003628 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3629 <name>.
3630
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003631 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3632 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3633 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3634 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3635 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3636 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3637 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3638 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3639
3640 Example:
3641
3642 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3643
3644 applied to:
3645
3646 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3647
3648 outputs:
3649
3650 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3651
3652 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3653
3654 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3655 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3656 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3657 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3658 header.
3659
3660 Example:
3661
3662 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3663
3664 applied to:
3665
3666 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3667
3668 outputs:
3669
3670 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3671
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003672 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
3673 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
3674 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
3675 it.
3676
3677 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
3678 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
3679 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
3680 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
3681 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
3682 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3683
3684 Example :
3685 # prepend the host name before the path
3686 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
3687
3688 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
3689 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
3690 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
3691 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
3692 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
3693 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
3694 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
3695 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3696
3697 Example :
3698 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
3699 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
3700
3701 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
3702 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
3703 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
3704 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
3705 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
3706 "set-query".
3707
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003708 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3709 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3710 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3711 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3712 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3713 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3714 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3715 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3716
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003717 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3718 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3719 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3720 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3721 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3722 another equipment.
3723
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003724 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3725 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3726 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3727 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3728 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3729 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3730 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3731 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3732
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003733 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3734 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3735 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3736 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3737 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3738 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3739 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3740 admin privileges.
3741
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003742 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3743 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3744 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3745 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3746 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3747 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3748 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3749 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3750
3751 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3752 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3753 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3754 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3755 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3756 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3757
3758 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3759 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3760 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3761 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3762 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3763 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3764
3765 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3766 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3767 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3768 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3769 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3770 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3771 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3772 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3773 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3774
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003775 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] :
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02003776 captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts
3777 it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
3778 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear
3779 next to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in
3780 the logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules
3781 to feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
3782 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
3783 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
3784 request header" for more information.
3785
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003786 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store
3787 the captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful
3788 to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous
3789 directive "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01003790 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
3791 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003792
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02003793 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
3794 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
3795 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
3796 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
3797 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
3798 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
3799 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
3800 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
3801 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
3802 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
3803 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
3804 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
3805
3806 These actions take one or two arguments :
3807 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
3808 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
3809 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
3810 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
3811
3812 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
3813 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
3814 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
3815 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
3816
3817 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
3818 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
3819 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
3820 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
3821 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
3822 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
3823 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
3824 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
3825
3826 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
3827 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
3828 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
3829 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
3830 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
3831
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003832 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
3833 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
3834 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
3835 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
3836 continues.
3837
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003838 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
3839 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
3840 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
3841 the actions evaluation continues.
3842
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003843 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr> :
3844 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
3845 inline.
3846
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003847 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
3848 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
3849 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
3850 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003851 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003852 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003853 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003854 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
3855 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003856 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003857 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003858 and '_'.
3859
3860 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3861 followed by some converters.
3862
3863 Example:
3864
3865 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
3866
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02003867 - set-src <expr> :
3868 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
3869 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP,
3870 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
3871 source IP for privacy.
3872
3873 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3874 followed by some converters.
3875
3876 Example:
3877
3878 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
3879 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
3880
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02003881 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
3882 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02003883
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02003884 - set-src-port <expr> :
3885 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
3886 expression.
3887
3888 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3889 followed by some converters.
3890
3891 Example:
3892
3893 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
3894 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
3895
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02003896 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
3897 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
3898 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02003899
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02003900 - set-dst <expr> :
3901 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
3902 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination
3903 IP, but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
3904 the IP for privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
3905 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
3906
3907 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3908 followed by some converters.
3909
3910 Example:
3911
3912 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
3913 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
3914
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02003915 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
3916 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
3917
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02003918 - set-dst-port <expr> :
3919 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
3920 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
3921 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
3922
3923 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3924 followed by some converters.
3925
3926 Example:
3927
3928 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
3929 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
3930
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02003931 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
3932 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
3933 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
3934
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003935 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
3936 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
3937 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
3938 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
3939 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
3940 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
3941 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
3942 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
3943 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
3944 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
3945 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
3946 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
3947 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
3948 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
3949 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
3950 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
3951
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003952 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
3953
3954 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
3955 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08003956 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
3957 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
3958
3959 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
3960 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
3961 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
3962 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003963
3964 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003965 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
3966 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
3967 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003968
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003969 http-request allow if nagios
3970 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
3971 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
3972 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003973
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003974 Example:
3975 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003976 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003977
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003978 Example:
3979 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
3980 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
Willy Tarreaufca42612015-08-27 17:15:05 +02003981 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003982 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
3983 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
3984 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
3985 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
3986 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
3987 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
3988
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003989 Example:
3990 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
3991 acl add path /addacl
3992 acl del path /delacl
3993
3994 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3995
3996 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
3997 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
3998
3999 Example:
4000 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4001 acl setmap path /setmap
4002 acl delmap path /delmap
4003
4004 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4005
4006 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4007 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
4008
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02004009 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4010 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004011
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004012http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004013 capture <sample> id <id> | redirect <rule> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004014 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004015 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
4016 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004017 set-status <status> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004018 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
4019 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4020 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4021 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01004022 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004023 set-var(<var-name>) <expr> |
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004024 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004025 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004026 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004027 silent-drop |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004028 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02004029 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004030 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4031
4032 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4033 no | yes | yes | yes
4034
4035 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4036 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4037 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4038 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4039 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4040 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4041
4042 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
4043 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
4044 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
4045 current section.
4046
4047 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
4048 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
4049 rules are evaluated.
4050
4051 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4052 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
4053 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
4054 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
4055 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4056 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
4057 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
4058
4059 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
4060 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4061 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4062 external users.
4063
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004064 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
4065 <name>.
4066
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004067 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
4068 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
4069 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
4070 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
4071 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4072 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
4073 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
4074 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
4075
4076 Example:
4077
4078 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4079
4080 applied to:
4081
4082 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4083
4084 outputs:
4085
4086 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4087
4088 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4089
4090 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
4091 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
4092 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
4093 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
4094 header.
4095
4096 Example:
4097
4098 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4099
4100 applied to:
4101
4102 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4103
4104 outputs:
4105
4106 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4107
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004108 - "set-status" replaces the response status code with <status> which must
4109 be an integer between 100 and 999. Note that the reason is automatically
4110 adapted to the new code.
4111
4112 Example:
4113
4114 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4115 http-response set-status 431
4116
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004117 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4118 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4119 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4120 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4121 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
4122 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
4123 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
4124 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4125
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004126 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
4127 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
4128 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
4129 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
4130 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
4131 another equipment.
4132
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004133 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
4134 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4135 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4136 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
4137 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
4138 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
4139 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
4140 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4141
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004142 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
4143 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
4144 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
4145 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
4146 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
4147 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
4148 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
4149 admin privileges.
4150
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004151 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4152 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4153 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4154 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
4155 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4156 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4157 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
4158 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4159
4160 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4161 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4162 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4163 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4164 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
4165 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4166
4167 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4168 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4169 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4170 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4171 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4172 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4173
4174 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4175 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4176 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
4177 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
4178 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4179 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4180 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4181 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4182 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4183
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004184 - capture <sample> id <id> :
4185 captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and converts
4186 it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4187 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4188 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4189 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4190 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
4191 response header" for more information.
4192
4193 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing
4194 the string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4195 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by
4196 a previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4197 keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01004198 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
4199 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004200
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004201 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4202 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4203 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible
4204 on the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When
4205 a redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server
4206 are closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
4207
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004208 - set-var(<var-name>) expr:
4209 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4210 inline.
4211
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004212 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
4213 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
4214 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4215 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004216 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004217 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004218 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004219 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4220 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004221 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004222 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004223 and '_'.
4224
4225 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4226 followed by some converters.
4227
4228 Example:
4229
4230 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4231
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004232 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
4233 enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer to
4234 "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
4235 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make
4236 use of samples in response (eg. res.*, status etc.) and samples below
4237 Layer 6 (eg. ssl related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is
4238 not supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
4239
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004240 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
4241 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
4242 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
4243 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
4244 continues.
4245
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004246 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4247 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4248 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4249 the actions evaluation continues.
4250
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004251 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4252 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4253 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4254 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4255 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4256 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4257 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4258 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4259 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4260 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4261 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4262 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4263 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4264 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4265 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4266 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4267
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004268 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
4269
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08004270 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004271 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4272 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004273 rules.
4274
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004275 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4276 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4277 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4278 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
4279
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004280 Example:
4281 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
4282
4283 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4284
4285 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4286 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4287
4288 Example:
4289 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4290
4291 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4292
4293 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4294 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
4295
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004296 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4297 ACL usage.
4298
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02004299
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004300http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
4301 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
4302
4303 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4304 yes | no | yes | yes
4305
4306 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
4307 belongs to the session that initiated it. The downside is that between the
4308 response and the next request, the connection remains idle and is not used.
4309 In many cases for performance reasons it is desirable to make it possible to
4310 reuse these idle connections to serve other requests from different sessions.
4311 This directive allows to tune this behaviour.
4312
4313 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
4314
4315 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This is
4316 the default choice. It may be enforced to cancel a different
4317 strategy inherited from a defaults section or for
4318 troubleshooting. For example, if an old bogus application
4319 considers that multiple requests over the same connection come
4320 from the same client and it is not possible to fix the
4321 application, it may be desirable to disable connection sharing
4322 in a single backend. An example of such an application could
4323 be an old haproxy using cookie insertion in tunnel mode and
4324 not checking any request past the first one.
4325
4326 - "safe" : this is the recommended strategy. The first request of a
4327 session is always sent over its own connection, and only
4328 subsequent requests may be dispatched over other existing
4329 connections. This ensures that in case the server closes the
4330 connection when the request is being sent, the browser can
4331 decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly equivalent to
4332 regular keep-alive, there should be no side effects.
4333
4334 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
4335 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
4336 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
4337 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
4338 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
4339 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
4340 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
4341 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
4342 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
4343 downsides of rare connection failures.
4344
4345 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
4346 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
4347 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
4348 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
4349 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
4350 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
4351 consistent behaviour and will benefit from the connection
4352 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
4353 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
4354 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
4355 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
4356 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
4357
4358 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
4359 connection properties and compatiblities. Specifically :
4360 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependant value
4361 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared ;
4362
4363 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
4364 and are never shared ;
4365
4366 - connections receiving a status code 401 or 407 expect some authentication
4367 to be sent in return. Due to certain bogus authentication schemes (such
4368 as NTLM) relying on the connection, these connections are marked private
4369 and are never shared ;
4370
4371 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
4372 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
4373 may not last after all sessions are closed.
4374
4375 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
4376 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
4377 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
4378
4379 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
4380
4381
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004382http-send-name-header [<header>]
4383 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
4384
4385 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4386 yes | no | yes | yes
4387
4388 Arguments :
4389
4390 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
4391
4392 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
4393 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
4394 is added with the header string proved.
4395
4396 See also : "server"
4397
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004398id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02004399 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
4400 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4401 no | yes | yes | yes
4402 Arguments : none
4403
4404 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
4405 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
4406 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004407
4408
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004409ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4410 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
4411 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4412 no | yes | yes | yes
4413
4414 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
4415 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
4416 and running).
4417
4418 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4419 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
4420 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004421 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004422 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
4423
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004424 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4425 "unless" condition is met.
4426
4427 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
4428
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004429load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
4430 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
4431 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4432 yes | no | yes | yes
4433
4434 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
4435 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
4436 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
4437 reload occured. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
4438 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
4439 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
4440 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
4441 over the stats socket and redirect output.
4442
4443 The format of the file is versionned and is very specific. To understand it,
4444 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02004445 9.2 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004446
4447 Arguments:
4448 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
4449 named "server-state-file".
4450
4451 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
4452 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
4453 name is used as a file name.
4454
4455 none don't load any stat for this backend
4456
4457 Notes:
4458 - server's IP address is not updated unless DNS resolution is enabled on
4459 the server. It means that if a server IP address has been changed using
4460 the stat socket, this information won't be re-applied after reloading.
4461
4462 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
4463 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
4464
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004465 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004466
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004467 global
4468 stats socket /tmp/socket
4469 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004470
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004471 defaults
4472 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004473
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004474 backend bk
4475 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4476 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004477
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004478
4479 Then one can run :
4480
4481 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
4482
4483 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
4484
4485 1
4486 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4487 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4488 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4489
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004490 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004491
4492 global
4493 stats socket /tmp/socket
4494 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
4495
4496 defaults
4497 load-server-state-from-file local
4498
4499 backend bk
4500 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4501 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
4502
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004503
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004504 Then one can run :
4505
4506 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
4507
4508 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
4509
4510 1
4511 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4512 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4513 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4514
4515 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
4516 "show servers state"
4517
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004518
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004519log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004520log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004521no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004522 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
4523 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4524 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004525
4526 Prefix :
4527 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
4528 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
4529 prefix does not allow arguments.
4530
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004531 Arguments :
4532 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
4533 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
4534 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
4535 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
4536 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
4537 parameter.
4538
4539 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
4540 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
4541
4542 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
4543 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4544 standard syslog port).
4545
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01004546 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
4547 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4548 standard syslog port).
4549
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004550 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
4551 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
4552 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
4553 appropriately writeable).
4554
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004555 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4556 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004557
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004558 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
4559 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
4560 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
4561 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
4562 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
4563 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
4564 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
4565 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
4566 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
4567 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
4568 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
4569
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004570 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
4571
4572 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
4573 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
4574 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
4575
4576 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
4577 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
4578 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004579 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
4580 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
4581 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
4582 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
4583 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004584
4585 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4586
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004587 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
4588 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
4589 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004590
4591 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
4592 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
4593 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
4594 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
4595
4596 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
4597 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004598
4599 Example :
4600 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004601 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
4602 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004603 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004604
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004605
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004606log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004607 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
4608 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4609 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004610
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004611 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
4612 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
4613 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
4614 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
4615 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004616
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02004617log-format-sd <string>
4618 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
4619 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4620 yes | yes | yes | no
4621
4622 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
4623 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
4624 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
4625 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
4626 which covers the log format string in depth.
4627
4628 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
4629 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
4630
4631 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
4632 log format to "rfc5424".
4633
4634 Example :
4635 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
4636
4637
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01004638log-tag <string>
4639 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
4640 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4641 yes | yes | yes | yes
4642
4643 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
4644 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
4645 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
4646 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
4647 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
4648 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
4649 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
4650 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
4651 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004652
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02004653max-keep-alive-queue <value>
4654 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
4655 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4656 yes | no | yes | yes
4657
4658 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
4659 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
4660 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
4661 servers.
4662
4663 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
4664 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
4665 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
4666 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
4667 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
4668 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
4669 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
4670 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
4671 picking a different server.
4672
4673 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
4674 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
4675 even if they have to be queued.
4676
4677 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
4678 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
4679
4680
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004681maxconn <conns>
4682 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
4683 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4684 yes | yes | yes | no
4685 Arguments :
4686 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
4687 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
4688 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
4689 closes.
4690
4691 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
4692 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
4693 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
4694 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01004695 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
4696 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
4697 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
4698 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004699
4700 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
4701 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
4702 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
4703
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02004704 By default, this value is set to 2000.
4705
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004706 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
4707
4708
4709mode { tcp|http|health }
4710 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
4711 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4712 yes | yes | yes | yes
4713 Arguments :
4714 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
4715 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
4716 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
4717 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
4718
4719 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
4720 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
4721 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
4722 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
4723 brings HAProxy most of its value.
4724
4725 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004726 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
4727 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
4728 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
4729 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
4730 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
4731 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
4732 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004733
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004734 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
4735 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
4736 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004737
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004738 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004739 defaults http_instances
4740 mode http
4741
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004742 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004743
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004744
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004745monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004746 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004747 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4748 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004749 Arguments :
4750 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
4751 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004752 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004753 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
4754 backend and its backup.
4755
4756 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
4757 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
4758 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
4759 servers in a list of backends.
4760
4761 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
4762 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
4763 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
4764 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
4765 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
4766 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
4767 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004768 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
4769 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004770
4771 Example:
4772 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004773 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004774 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
4775 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
4776 monitor-uri /site_alive
4777 monitor fail if site_dead
4778
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004779 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004780
4781
4782monitor-net <source>
4783 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
4784 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4785 yes | yes | yes | no
4786 Arguments :
4787 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
4788 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
4789 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
4790 followed by a mask.
4791
4792 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
4793 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004794 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004795 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
4796
4797 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
4798 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
4799 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
4800 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004801 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
4802 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
4803 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004804
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004805 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
4806 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
4807 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
4808 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
4809 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
4810 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004811
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01004812 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
4813 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004814
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004815 Example :
4816 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
4817 frontend www
4818 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
4819
4820 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
4821
4822
4823monitor-uri <uri>
4824 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
4825 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4826 yes | yes | yes | no
4827 Arguments :
4828 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
4829 health status instead of forwarding the request.
4830
4831 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
4832 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
4833 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
4834 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
4835 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
4836 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
4837 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
4838 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
4839
4840 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
4841 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
4842 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
4843 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
4844 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
4845 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
4846
4847 Example :
4848 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
4849 frontend www
4850 mode http
4851 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
4852
4853 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
4854
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004855
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004856option abortonclose
4857no option abortonclose
4858 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
4859 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4860 yes | no | yes | yes
4861 Arguments : none
4862
4863 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
4864 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
4865 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
4866 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004867 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004868 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
4869 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
4870 encountered while delivering the response.
4871
4872 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
4873 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
4874 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
4875 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
4876 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
4877 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004878 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004879 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004880 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004881 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
4882 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
4883 still not served and not pollute the servers.
4884
4885 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
4886 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
4887 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
4888 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
4889 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
4890 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
4891 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
4892 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004893 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004894
4895 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4896 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4897
4898 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
4899
4900
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004901option accept-invalid-http-request
4902no option accept-invalid-http-request
4903 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
4904 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4905 yes | yes | yes | no
4906 Arguments : none
4907
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004908 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004909 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4910 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4911 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4912 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4913 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4914 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4915 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004916 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
4917 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
4918 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
4919 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
4920 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004921 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02004922 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
4923 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
4924 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004925
4926 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4927 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4928 been confirmed.
4929
4930 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4931 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004932 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
4933 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004934 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4935
4936 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4937 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4938
4939 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
4940 stats socket.
4941
4942
4943option accept-invalid-http-response
4944no option accept-invalid-http-response
4945 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
4946 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4947 yes | no | yes | yes
4948 Arguments : none
4949
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004950 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004951 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4952 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4953 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4954 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4955 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4956 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4957 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004958 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
4959 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
4960 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004961
4962 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4963 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4964 been confirmed.
4965
4966 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4967 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
4968 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
4969 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4970
4971 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4972 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4973
4974 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
4975 stats socket.
4976
4977
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004978option allbackups
4979no option allbackups
4980 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
4981 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4982 yes | no | yes | yes
4983 Arguments : none
4984
4985 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
4986 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
4987 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
4988 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
4989 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
4990 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
4991 order between the backup servers anymore.
4992
4993 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
4994 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
4995
4996 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4997 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4998
4999
5000option checkcache
5001no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005002 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005003 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5004 yes | no | yes | yes
5005 Arguments : none
5006
5007 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5008 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005009 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005010 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5011 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005012 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005013
5014 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005015 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005016 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005017 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5018 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005019 to the client are :
5020 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005021 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005022 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005023 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
5024 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
5025 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5026 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5027 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5028 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5029 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5030 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5031 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5032 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5033 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5034
5035 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005036 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005037 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005038 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005039 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
5040
5041 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5042 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005043 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005044 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
5045
5046 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5047 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5048
5049
5050option clitcpka
5051no option clitcpka
5052 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5053 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5054 yes | yes | yes | no
5055 Arguments : none
5056
5057 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5058 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5059 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5060 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5061
5062 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5063 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5064 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5065 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5066
5067 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5068 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5069 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5070 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5071 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5072
5073 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5074
5075 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5076 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5077 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5078
5079 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5080 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5081
5082 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5083
5084
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005085option contstats
5086 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5087 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5088 yes | yes | yes | no
5089 Arguments : none
5090
5091 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5092 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5093 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5094 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
5095 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
5096 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
5097 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
5098
5099
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005100option dontlog-normal
5101no option dontlog-normal
5102 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5103 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5104 yes | yes | yes | no
5105 Arguments : none
5106
5107 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
5108 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
5109 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
5110 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
5111 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
5112 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
5113 logged.
5114
5115 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
5116 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
5117 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
5118
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005119 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005120 logging.
5121
5122
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005123option dontlognull
5124no option dontlognull
5125 Enable or disable logging of null connections
5126 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5127 yes | yes | yes | no
5128 Arguments : none
5129
5130 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
5131 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
5132 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
5133 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
5134 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
5135 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005136 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
5137 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
5138 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005139
5140 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
5141 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
5142 would not be logged.
5143
5144 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5145 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5146
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005147 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
5148 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005149
5150
5151option forceclose
5152no option forceclose
5153 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
5154 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01005155 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005156 Arguments : none
5157
5158 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
5159 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
5160 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
5161 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
5162 global session times in the logs.
5163
5164 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01005165 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005166 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005167
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005168 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
5169 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
5170 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
5171
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005172 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5173 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005174
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005175 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5176 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5177
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005178 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005179
5180
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005181option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005182 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
5183 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5184 yes | yes | yes | yes
5185 Arguments :
5186 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5187 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005188 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005189 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005190
5191 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
5192 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
5193 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
5194 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
5195 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
5196 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
5197 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005198 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
5199 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5200 possible that the client has already brought one.
5201
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005202 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005203 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005204 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
5205 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005206 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
5207 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005208
5209 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5210 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5211 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5212 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5213 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5214 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5215 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5216
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005217 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
5218 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
5219 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
5220 are under the control of the end-user.
5221
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005222 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005223 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5224 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005225 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
5226 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
5227 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005228
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005229 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005230 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
5231 frontend www
5232 mode http
5233 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
5234
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005235 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
5236 backend www
5237 mode http
5238 option forwardfor header X-Client
5239
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005240 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005241 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005242
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005243
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005244option http-buffer-request
5245no option http-buffer-request
5246 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
5247 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5248 yes | yes | yes | yes
5249 Arguments : none
5250
5251 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
5252 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
5253 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
5254 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
5255 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
5256 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
5257 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
5258 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
5259 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbufferred transmissions between
5260 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
5261 default.
5262
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01005263 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005264
5265
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005266option http-ignore-probes
5267no option http-ignore-probes
5268 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
5269 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5270 yes | yes | yes | no
5271 Arguments : none
5272
5273 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
5274 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
5275 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
5276 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
5277 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
5278 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
5279 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
5280 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
5281 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
5282 was received over a connection before it was closed ;
5283 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation ;
5284 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
5285
5286 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
5287 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
5288 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
5289 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
5290 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
5291 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
5292 are often the only way to detect them.
5293
5294 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5295 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5296
5297 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
5298
5299
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005300option http-keep-alive
5301no option http-keep-alive
5302 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
5303 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5304 yes | yes | yes | yes
5305 Arguments : none
5306
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005307 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5308 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5309 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
5310 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
5311 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5312 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
5313 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
5314
5315 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
5316 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005317 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
5318 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
5319 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
5320 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
5321 situations where this option may be useful :
5322
5323 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
5324 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
5325
5326 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
5327 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
5328
5329 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
5330 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
5331 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
5332 request.
5333
5334 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
5335 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005336 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
5337 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
5338 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005339
5340 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
5341 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
5342
5343 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5344 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5345 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5346 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
5347 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5348 not set.
5349
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005350 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5351 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005352 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005353 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005354
5355 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005356 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
5357 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005358
5359
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005360option http-no-delay
5361no option http-no-delay
5362 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
5363 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5364 yes | yes | yes | yes
5365 Arguments : none
5366
5367 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
5368 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
5369 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
5370 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
5371 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
5372 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
5373 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
5374 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
5375 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
5376 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
5377 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
5378 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
5379 affected.
5380
5381 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
5382 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
5383 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
5384 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
5385 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
5386 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
5387 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
5388 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
5389 latency environments.
5390
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005391 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
5392
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005393
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005394option http-pretend-keepalive
5395no option http-pretend-keepalive
5396 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
5397 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5398 yes | yes | yes | yes
5399 Arguments : none
5400
5401 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
5402 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
5403 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
5404 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
5405 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
5406 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
5407 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
5408 consider the response complete.
5409
5410 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
5411 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
5412 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
5413 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
5414 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
5415 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
5416
5417 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
5418 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
5419 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
5420 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
5421 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
5422 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
5423 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
5424
5425 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5426 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005427 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02005428 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
5429 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005430
5431 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5432 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5433
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005434 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
5435 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005436
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005437
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005438option http-server-close
5439no option http-server-close
5440 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
5441 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5442 yes | yes | yes | yes
5443 Arguments : none
5444
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005445 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5446 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5447 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5448 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5449 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5450 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
5451 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
5452 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
5453 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
5454 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
5455 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
5456 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
5457 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
5458 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
5459 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
5460 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005461
5462 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5463 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5464 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5465 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005466 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5467 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005468
5469 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5470 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005471 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
5472 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005473 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
5474 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005475
5476 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5477 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5478
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005479 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005480 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5481 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005482
5483
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005484option http-tunnel
5485no option http-tunnel
5486 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
5487 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5488 yes | yes | yes | yes
5489 Arguments : none
5490
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005491 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5492 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5493 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5494 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5495 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5496 "option http-tunnel".
5497
5498 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005499 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005500 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
5501 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
5502 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
5503 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
5504 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
5505 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
5506 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005507
5508 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5509 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5510
5511 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
5512 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5513 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
5514
5515
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005516option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005517no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005518 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
5519 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5520 yes | yes | yes | no
5521 Arguments : none
5522
5523 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
5524 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
5525 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
5526 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
5527 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
5528 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
5529 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
5530
5531 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
5532 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005533 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
5534 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
5535 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005536
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01005537 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
5538 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
5539 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
5540 front of an existing proxy.
5541
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005542 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
5543
5544 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
5545 http-server-close".
5546
5547
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005548option httpchk
5549option httpchk <uri>
5550option httpchk <method> <uri>
5551option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
5552 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
5553 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5554 yes | no | yes | yes
5555 Arguments :
5556 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
5557 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
5558 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
5559 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
5560 ones.
5561
5562 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
5563 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5564 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5565
5566 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
5567 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
5568 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
5569 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
5570 after "\r\n" following the version string.
5571
5572 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
5573 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
5574 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
5575 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
5576 the lack of any response.
5577
5578 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
5579
5580 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
5581 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
5582 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
5583
5584 Examples :
5585 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
5586 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
5587 backend https_relay
5588 mode tcp
5589 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
5590 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
5591
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09005592 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
5593 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
5594 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005595
5596
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005597option httpclose
5598no option httpclose
5599 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
5600 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5601 yes | yes | yes | yes
5602 Arguments : none
5603
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005604 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5605 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5606 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5607 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005608 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005609 "option http-tunnel".
5610
5611 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
5612 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
5613 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
5614 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
5615 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
5616 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
5617 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
5618 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005619
5620 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005621 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01005622 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
5623 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
5624 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
5625 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
5626 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005627
5628 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5629 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005630 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
5631 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005632 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
5633 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005634
5635 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5636 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5637
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005638 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
5639 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005640
5641
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005642option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005643 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
5644 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5645 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005646 Arguments :
5647 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
5648 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
5649 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
5650 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
5651 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005652
5653 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5654 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5655 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
5656 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
5657 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
5658 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
5659 ports.
5660
5661 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5662
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01005663 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
5664 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005665
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005666 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005667
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005668
5669option http_proxy
5670no option http_proxy
5671 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
5672 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5673 yes | yes | yes | yes
5674 Arguments : none
5675
5676 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
5677 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
5678 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
5679 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
5680 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
5681
5682 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
5683 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005684 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
5685 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005686
5687 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5688 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5689
5690 Example :
5691 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
5692 backend direct_forward
5693 option httpclose
5694 option http_proxy
5695
5696 See also : "option httpclose"
5697
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005698
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005699option independent-streams
5700no option independent-streams
5701 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005702 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5703 yes | yes | yes | yes
5704 Arguments : none
5705
5706 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
5707 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
5708 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
5709 receive data or not.
5710
5711 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
5712 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
5713 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
5714 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
5715 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
5716 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
5717 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
5718 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
5719 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
5720 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
5721 socket buffers.
5722
5723 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
5724 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
5725 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
5726 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
5727 slow lines, so use it with caution.
5728
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005729 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005730 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
5731 deprecated.
5732
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005733 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005734
5735
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02005736option ldap-check
5737 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
5738 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5739 yes | no | yes | yes
5740 Arguments : none
5741
5742 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
5743 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
5744 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
5745 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
5746
5747 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
5748 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
5749
5750 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
5751 configure it.
5752
5753 Example :
5754 option ldap-check
5755
5756 See also : "option httpchk"
5757
5758
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005759option external-check
5760 Use external processes for server health checks
5761 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5762 yes | no | yes | yes
5763
5764 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
5765 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
5766 command".
5767
5768 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
5769
5770 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
5771
5772
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005773option log-health-checks
5774no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005775 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005776 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5777 yes | no | yes | yes
5778 Arguments : none
5779
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005780 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
5781 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
5782 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005783
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005784 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
5785 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
5786 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
5787 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
5788 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
5789
5790 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
5791 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005792
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005793 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
5794 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
5795 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005796
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005797
5798option log-separate-errors
5799no option log-separate-errors
5800 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
5801 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5802 yes | yes | yes | no
5803 Arguments : none
5804
5805 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
5806 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
5807 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
5808 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
5809 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
5810 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
5811 provides very important information.
5812
5813 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
5814 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
5815 error logs.
5816
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005817 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005818 logging.
5819
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005820
5821option logasap
5822no option logasap
5823 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
5824 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5825 yes | yes | yes | no
5826 Arguments : none
5827
5828 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
5829 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
5830 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
5831 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
5832 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
5833 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
5834 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005835 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005836 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
5837 bytes are expected to be transferred.
5838
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005839 Examples :
5840 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
5841 mode http
5842 option httplog
5843 option logasap
5844 log 192.168.2.200 local3
5845
5846 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
5847 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
5848 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
5849 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
5850
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005851 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005852 logging.
5853
5854
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005855option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005856 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005857 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5858 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005859 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005860 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
5861 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005862 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005863
5864 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
5865 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
5866 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
5867 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
5868 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
5869 in the MySQL table, like this :
5870
5871 USE mysql;
5872 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
5873 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
5874
5875 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
5876 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
5877 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
5878 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
5879 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
5880 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
5881 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
5882 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
5883 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
5884
5885 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
5886 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005887
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02005888 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005889
5890 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
5891 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
5892 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
5893 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02005894 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
5895 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005896
5897 See also: "option httpchk"
5898
5899
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005900option nolinger
5901no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005902 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005903 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5904 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005905 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005906
5907 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
5908 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
5909 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
5910 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
5911 connections.
5912
5913 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
5914 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
5915 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
5916 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
5917 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
5918 this too.
5919
5920 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
5921 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
5922 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
5923
5924 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
5925 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
5926 for servers.
5927
5928 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5929 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5930
5931
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005932option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
5933 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
5934 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5935 yes | yes | yes | yes
5936 Arguments :
5937 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5938 matching <network>
5939 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
5940 header name.
5941
5942 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
5943 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
5944 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
5945 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
5946 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
5947 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
5948 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
5949 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
5950 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5951 possible that the client has already brought one.
5952
5953 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
5954 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
5955 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
5956 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
5957 header and requires different one.
5958
5959 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5960 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5961 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5962 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5963 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5964 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5965 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5966
5967 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
5968 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5969 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
5970 both are defined.
5971
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005972 Examples :
5973 # Original Destination address
5974 frontend www
5975 mode http
5976 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
5977
5978 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
5979 backend www
5980 mode http
5981 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
5982
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005983 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
5984 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005985
5986
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005987option persist
5988no option persist
5989 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
5990 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5991 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005992 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005993
5994 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
5995 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
5996 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
5997 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
5998 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
5999 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6000 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6001 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6002 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6003 redirected to another valid server.
6004
6005 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6006 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6007
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006008 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006009
6010
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006011option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6012 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6013 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6014 yes | no | yes | yes
6015 Arguments :
6016 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6017 PostgreSQL server.
6018
6019 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6020 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6021 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6022 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6023
6024 See also: "option httpchk"
6025
6026
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006027option prefer-last-server
6028no option prefer-last-server
6029 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6030 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6031 yes | no | yes | yes
6032 Arguments : none
6033
6034 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6035 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6036 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6037 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6038 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6039 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6040 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6041 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6042 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006043 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6044 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
6045 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
6046 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
6047 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6048 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6049 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006050
6051 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6052 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6053
6054 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6055
6056
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006057option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006058option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006059no option redispatch
6060 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6061 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6062 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006063 Arguments :
6064 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6065 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6066 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
6067 N indicate a redispath is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
6068 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
6069 historical behaviour of redispatching on the last retry, a
6070 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6071 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6072 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6073
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006074
6075 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6076 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6077 be able to access the service anymore.
6078
6079 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
6080 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
6081
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006082 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006083 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6084 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006085
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006086 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
6087 "redisp" keywords.
6088
6089 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6090 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6091
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006092 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006093
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006094
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006095option redis-check
6096 Use redis health checks for server testing
6097 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6098 yes | no | yes | yes
6099 Arguments : none
6100
6101 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6102 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6103 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6104 find the "+PONG" response message.
6105
6106 Example :
6107 option redis-check
6108
6109 See also : "option httpchk"
6110
6111
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006112option smtpchk
6113option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
6114 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
6115 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6116 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006117 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006118 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
6119 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
6120 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
6121
6122 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
6123 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
6124 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
6125
6126 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
6127 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
6128 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
6129 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
6130 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
6131 dead server.
6132
6133 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
6134 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
6135 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
6136 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
6137
6138 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
6139 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
6140 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6141 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006142 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006143
6144 Example :
6145 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
6146
6147 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
6148
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006149
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02006150option socket-stats
6151no option socket-stats
6152
6153 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
6154 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6155 yes | yes | yes | no
6156
6157 Arguments : none
6158
6159
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006160option splice-auto
6161no option splice-auto
6162 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
6163 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6164 yes | yes | yes | yes
6165 Arguments : none
6166
6167 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
6168 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
6169 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
6170 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006171 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006172 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
6173 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
6174 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
6175 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6176
6177 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
6178 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
6179 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
6180 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
6181 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
6182 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
6183 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
6184 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
6185 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
6186 keyword.
6187
6188 Example :
6189 option splice-auto
6190
6191 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6192 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6193
6194 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
6195 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6196
6197
6198option splice-request
6199no option splice-request
6200 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
6201 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6202 yes | yes | yes | yes
6203 Arguments : none
6204
6205 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006206 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006207 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6208 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6209 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6210 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6211
6212 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6213
6214 Example :
6215 option splice-request
6216
6217 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6218 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6219
6220 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
6221 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6222
6223
6224option splice-response
6225no option splice-response
6226 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
6227 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6228 yes | yes | yes | yes
6229 Arguments : none
6230
6231 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006232 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006233 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6234 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6235 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6236 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6237
6238 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6239
6240 Example :
6241 option splice-response
6242
6243 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6244 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6245
6246 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
6247 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6248
6249
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006250option srvtcpka
6251no option srvtcpka
6252 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
6253 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6254 yes | no | yes | yes
6255 Arguments : none
6256
6257 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6258 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6259 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6260 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6261
6262 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6263 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6264 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6265 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6266
6267 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6268 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6269 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6270 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6271 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6272
6273 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6274
6275 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6276 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6277 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
6278
6279 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6280 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6281
6282 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
6283
6284
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006285option ssl-hello-chk
6286 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
6287 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6288 yes | no | yes | yes
6289 Arguments : none
6290
6291 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
6292 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
6293 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
6294 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
6295 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
6296 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
6297 hello message.
6298
6299 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
6300 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
6301 messages, which is appreciable.
6302
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006303 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
6304 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
6305 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006306
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006307 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
6308
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006309
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006310option tcp-check
6311 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
6312 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6313 yes | no | yes | yes
6314
6315 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
6316 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
6317
6318 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
6319 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
6320 attempt, which remains the default mode.
6321
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006322 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006323 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
6324 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
6325 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
6326 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
6327 only.
6328
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006329 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006330 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
6331 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
6332 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
6333 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
6334
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006335 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006336 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
6337 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006338 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006339 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
6340 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
6341 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
6342 the respective protocols.
6343 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
6344 analysed.
6345
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006346 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
6347 script.
6348
6349 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
6350 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
6351 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
6352 The "comment" is of course optional.
6353
6354
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006355 Examples :
6356 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
6357 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006358 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006359
6360 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
6361 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006362 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006363
6364 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
6365 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006366 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006367 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006368 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006369 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02006370 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006371 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006372 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
6373 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006374 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006375 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
6376 tcp-check expect string +OK
6377
6378 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
6379 (send many headers before analyzing)
6380 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006381 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006382 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
6383 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
6384 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
6385 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006386 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006387
6388
6389 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
6390
6391
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006392option tcp-smart-accept
6393no option tcp-smart-accept
6394 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
6395 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6396 yes | yes | yes | no
6397 Arguments : none
6398
6399 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
6400 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
6401 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
6402 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
6403 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
6404 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
6405
6406 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
6407 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
6408 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
6409 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
6410
6411 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
6412 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
6413 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
6414 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
6415
6416 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
6417 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
6418 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
6419
6420 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
6421 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
6422 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
6423
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02006424 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
6425
6426
6427option tcp-smart-connect
6428no option tcp-smart-connect
6429 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
6430 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6431 yes | no | yes | yes
6432 Arguments : none
6433
6434 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
6435 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
6436 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
6437 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
6438 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
6439
6440 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
6441 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
6442 complex.
6443
6444 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
6445 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
6446 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
6447
6448 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6449 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6450
6451 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
6452
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006453
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006454option tcpka
6455 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
6456 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6457 yes | yes | yes | yes
6458 Arguments : none
6459
6460 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6461 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6462 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6463 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6464
6465 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6466 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6467 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6468 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6469
6470 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6471 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6472 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6473 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6474 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6475
6476 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6477
6478 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
6479 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
6480 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
6481 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
6482 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
6483 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
6484 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
6485 backends.
6486
6487 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
6488
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006489
6490option tcplog
6491 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
6492 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6493 yes | yes | yes | yes
6494 Arguments : none
6495
6496 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6497 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6498 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
6499 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
6500 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
6501 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
6502 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
6503 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
6504
6505 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
6506
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006507 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006508
6509
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006510option transparent
6511no option transparent
6512 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6513 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006514 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006515 Arguments : none
6516
6517 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
6518 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6519 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6520 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6521 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6522 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6523 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6524 appropriate server.
6525
6526 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6527 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6528
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01006529 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006530 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006531
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006532
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006533external-check command <command>
6534 Executable to run when performing an external-check
6535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6536 yes | no | yes | yes
6537
6538 Arguments :
6539 <command> is the external command to run
6540
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006541 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
6542
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006543 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006544
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006545 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
6546 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
6547 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
6548 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
6549 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
6550 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006551
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01006552 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
6553
6554 Environment variables :
6555 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
6556 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
6557
6558 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
6559
6560 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
6561
6562 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
6563 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
6564 for a UNIX socket).
6565
6566 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
6567
6568 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
6569
6570 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
6571
6572 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
6573
6574 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
6575
6576 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
6577 socket).
6578
6579 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
6580 the command may be set using "external-check path".
6581
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006582 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
6583 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
6584 failed.
6585
6586 Example :
6587 external-check command /bin/true
6588
6589 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
6590
6591
6592external-check path <path>
6593 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
6594 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6595 yes | no | yes | yes
6596
6597 Arguments :
6598 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
6599
6600 The default path is "".
6601
6602 Example :
6603 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
6604
6605 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
6606 "external-check command"
6607
6608
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006609persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02006610persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006611 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
6612 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6613 yes | no | yes | yes
6614 Arguments :
6615 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006616 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
6617 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006618
6619 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
6620 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
6621 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
6622 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
6623 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
6624 forwarded to this server.
6625
6626 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
6627 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
6628 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006629 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006630 a single "listen" section.
6631
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006632 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
6633 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
6634 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
6635
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006636 Example :
6637 listen tse-farm
6638 bind :3389
6639 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
6640 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6641 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
6642 # apply RDP cookie persistence
6643 persist rdp-cookie
6644 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006645 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006646 balance rdp-cookie
6647 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
6648 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
6649
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09006650 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
6651 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006652
6653
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006654rate-limit sessions <rate>
6655 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
6656 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6657 yes | yes | yes | no
6658 Arguments :
6659 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
6660 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
6661
6662 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
6663 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
6664 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
6665 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
6666 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
6667 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
6668
6669 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
6670 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
6671 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
6672 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
6673
6674 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
6675 listen smtp
6676 mode tcp
6677 bind :25
6678 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02006679 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006680
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02006681 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
6682 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
6683 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006684
6685 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
6686
6687
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006688redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6689redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6690redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006691 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
6692 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6693 no | yes | yes | yes
6694
6695 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01006696 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006697
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006698 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006699 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006700 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
6701 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
6702 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006703
6704 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
6705 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
6706 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
6707 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
6708 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006709 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
6710 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
6711 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
6712 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006713
6714 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
6715 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
6716 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
6717 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
6718 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
6719 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006720 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006721 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006722 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
6723 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
6724 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006725
6726 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006727 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
6728 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
6729 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02006730 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006731 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
6732 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
6733 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
6734 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006735
6736 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
6737 expected behaviour of a redirection :
6738
6739 - "drop-query"
6740 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
6741 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
6742 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
6743 with a location-type redirect.
6744
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006745 - "append-slash"
6746 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
6747 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
6748 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
6749 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
6750
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006751 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
6752 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
6753 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
6754 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
6755 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
6756 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
6757 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
6758
6759 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
6760 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
6761 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
6762 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
6763 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
6764 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
6765 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006766
6767 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
6768 acl clear dst_port 80
6769 acl secure dst_port 8080
6770 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006771 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006772 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006773 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
6774
6775 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006776 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
6777 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
6778 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006779 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006780
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006781 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
6782 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
6783 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
6784
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006785 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01006786 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006787
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006788 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02006789 http-request redirect code 301 location \
6790 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
6791 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006792
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006793 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006794
6795
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006796redisp (deprecated)
6797redispatch (deprecated)
6798 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6799 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6800 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006801 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006802
6803 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6804 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6805 be able to access the service anymore.
6806
6807 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
6808 redistribute them to a working server.
6809
6810 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
6811 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6812 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006813
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006814 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
6815 "option redispatch" instead.
6816
6817 See also : "option redispatch"
6818
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006819
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006820reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006821 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
6822 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6823 no | yes | yes | yes
6824 Arguments :
6825 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6826 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006827 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006828
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006829 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6830 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6831
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006832 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
6833 the last header of an HTTP request.
6834
6835 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6836 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6837 responses.
6838
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006839 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
6840 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
6841 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
6842
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006843 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
6844 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006845
6846
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006847reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6848reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006849 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
6850 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6851 no | yes | yes | yes
6852 Arguments :
6853 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6854 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6855 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6856 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6857 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6858 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
6859 ignores case.
6860
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006861 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6862 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6863
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006864 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6865 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
6866 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
6867 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006868 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006869
6870 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6871 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6872
6873 Example :
6874 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
6875 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6876 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6877
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006878 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
6879 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006880
6881
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006882reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6883reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006884 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
6885 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6886 no | yes | yes | yes
6887 Arguments :
6888 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6889 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6890 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6891 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6892 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
6893 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
6894
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006895 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6896 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6897
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006898 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
6899 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
6900 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
6901 next servers.
6902
6903 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6904 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6905 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
6906
6907 Example :
6908 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
6909 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
6910 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
6911
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006912 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
6913 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006914
6915
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006916reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6917reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006918 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
6919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6920 no | yes | yes | yes
6921 Arguments :
6922 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6923 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6924 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6925 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6926 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6927 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
6928 case.
6929
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006930 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6931 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6932
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006933 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6934 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
6935 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
6936 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006937 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006938
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006939 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006940 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006941 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006942
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006943 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6944 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6945
6946 Example :
6947 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
6948 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6949 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6950
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006951 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
6952 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006953
6954
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006955reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6956reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006957 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
6958 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6959 no | yes | yes | yes
6960 Arguments :
6961 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6962 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6963 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6964 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6965 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6966 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
6967 case.
6968
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006969 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6970 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6971
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006972 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6973 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
6974 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
6975 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
6976
6977 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6978 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6979
6980 Example :
6981 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
6982 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
6983 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6984 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6985
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006986 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
6987 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006988
6989
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006990reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6991reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006992 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
6993 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6994 no | yes | yes | yes
6995 Arguments :
6996 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6997 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6998 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6999 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7000 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
7001 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
7002
7003 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7004 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7005 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7006 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007007 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007008
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007009 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7010 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7011
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007012 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
7013 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
7014 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
7015
7016 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7017 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7018 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7019 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
7020 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7021
7022 Example :
7023 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007024 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007025 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
7026 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
7027
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007028 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
7029 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007030
7031
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007032reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7033reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007034 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
7035 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7036 no | yes | yes | yes
7037 Arguments :
7038 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7039 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7040 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7041 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7042 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7043 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
7044 ignores case.
7045
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007046 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7047 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7048
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007049 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7050 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007051 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
7052 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
7053 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007054 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
7055 not set.
7056
7057 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
7058 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
7059 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
7060 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
7061 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
7062
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007063 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007064 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
7065 # block all others.
7066 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
7067 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
7068
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007069 # block bad guys
7070 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
7071 reqitarpit . if badguys
7072
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007073 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
7074 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007075
7076
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007077retries <value>
7078 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7079 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7080 yes | no | yes | yes
7081 Arguments :
7082 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7083 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7084 default value is 3.
7085
7086 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7087 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7088 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7089
7090 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007091 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7092 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007093
7094 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7095 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7096
7097 See also : "option redispatch"
7098
7099
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007100rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007101 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
7102 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7103 no | yes | yes | yes
7104 Arguments :
7105 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7106 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007107 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007108
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007109 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7110 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7111
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007112 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7113 the last header of an HTTP response.
7114
7115 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7116 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7117 responses.
7118
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007119 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
7120 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007121
7122
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007123rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7124rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007125 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
7126 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7127 no | yes | yes | yes
7128 Arguments :
7129 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7130 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7131 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7132 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7133 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7134 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
7135 ignores case.
7136
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007137 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7138 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7139
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007140 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
7141 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007142 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007143 client.
7144
7145 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7146 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7147 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7148
7149 Example :
7150 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02007151 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007152
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007153 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
7154 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007155
7156
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007157rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7158rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007159 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
7160 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7161 no | yes | yes | yes
7162 Arguments :
7163 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7164 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7165 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7166 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7167 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7168 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
7169 ignores case.
7170
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007171 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7172 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7173
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007174 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7175 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
7176 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
7177 case-sensitive.
7178
7179 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007180 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
7181 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
7182 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007183
7184 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7185 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
7186
7187 Example :
7188 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
7189 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
7190
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007191 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
7192 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007193
7194
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007195rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7196rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007197 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
7198 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7199 no | yes | yes | yes
7200 Arguments :
7201 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7202 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7203 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7204 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7205 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7206 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
7207 ignores case.
7208
7209 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7210 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7211 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7212 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007213 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007214
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007215 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7216 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7217
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007218 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
7219 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
7220 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
7221
7222 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7223 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7224 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7225 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
7226 are not case-sensitive.
7227
7228 Example :
7229 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
7230 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
7231
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007232 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
7233 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007234
7235
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007236server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007237 Declare a server in a backend
7238 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7239 no | no | yes | yes
7240 Arguments :
7241 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02007242 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007243 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007244
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007245 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7246 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7247 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7248 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007249 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7250 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7251 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7252 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7253 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007254 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7255 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7256 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7257 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7258 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7259 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7260 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007261 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007262 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7263 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
7264 variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007265
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007266 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007267 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
7268 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
7269 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
7270 adding this value to the client's port.
7271
7272 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
7273 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007274 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007275
7276 Examples :
7277 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
7278 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007279 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007280 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
7281 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
7282 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007283
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02007284 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
7285 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
7286 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
7287 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
7288 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
7289
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007290 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
7291 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007292
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007293server-state-file-name [<file>]
7294 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
7295 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
7296 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
7297 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
7298 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
7299 global directive "server-state-file-base".
7300
7301 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
7302 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
7303
7304 global
7305 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
7306
7307 backend bk
7308 load-server-state-from-file
7309
7310 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
7311 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007312
7313source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007314source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007315source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007316 Set the source address for outgoing connections
7317 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7318 yes | no | yes | yes
7319 Arguments :
7320 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
7321 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007322
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007323 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007324 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
7325 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
7326 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
7327 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
7328 supported prefixes are :
7329 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7330 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7331 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007332 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02007333 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7334 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007335
7336 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
7337 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007338 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
7339 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
7340 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007341
7342 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
7343 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
7344 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
7345 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
7346 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
7347 <addr>.
7348
7349 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
7350 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
7351 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
7352 port.
7353
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007354 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
7355 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
7356 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
7357 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01007358 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007359 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
7360 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
7361 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
7362 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
7363 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
7364 HTTP header.
7365
7366 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
7367 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007368 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007369 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
7370 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
7371 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
7372 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
7373 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
7374 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
7375 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
7376
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007377 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
7378 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
7379 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
7380 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
7381 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
7382 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
7383
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007384 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
7385 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
7386 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
7387 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
7388
7389 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
7390 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
7391 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
7392 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
7393 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
7394 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
7395
7396 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
7397 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
7398 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
7399 there are two methods :
7400
7401 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
7402 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
7403 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
7404 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
7405 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
7406 of the client ranges may be used.
7407
7408 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
7409 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
7410 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
7411 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
7412 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
7413 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
7414 same session.
7415
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007416 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
7417 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
7418 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007419 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007420
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02007421 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
7422
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007423 Examples :
7424 backend private
7425 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
7426 source 192.168.1.200
7427
7428 backend transparent_ssl1
7429 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
7430 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7431
7432 backend transparent_ssl2
7433 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
7434 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
7435 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
7436
7437 backend transparent_ssl3
7438 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
7439 # is more conntrack-friendly.
7440 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7441
7442 backend transparent_smtp
7443 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
7444 # with Tproxy version 4.
7445 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
7446
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007447 backend transparent_http
7448 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
7449 # proxy.
7450 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
7451
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007452 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007453 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
7454
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007455
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007456srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7457 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7458 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7459 yes | no | yes | yes
7460 Arguments :
7461 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7462 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7463 as explained at the top of this document.
7464
7465 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7466 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7467 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7468 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7469 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7470 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7471 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7472
7473 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7474 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7475 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7476 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7477 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007478 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007479 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007480 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007481
7482 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7483 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7484 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7485 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7486 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7487 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7488
7489 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
7490 Please use "timeout server" instead.
7491
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007492 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
7493 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007494
7495
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007496stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
7497 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
7498 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007499 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007500
7501 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
7502 matched.
7503
7504 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
7505 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
7506
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007507 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7508 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7509 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7510
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01007511 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
7512 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
7513 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
7514 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007515
7516 Example :
7517 # statistics admin level only for localhost
7518 backend stats_localhost
7519 stats enable
7520 stats admin if LOCALHOST
7521
7522 Example :
7523 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
7524 backend stats_auth
7525 stats enable
7526 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
7527 stats admin if TRUE
7528
7529 Example :
7530 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
7531 userlist stats-auth
7532 group admin users admin
7533 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
7534 group readonly users haproxy
7535 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
7536
7537 backend stats_auth
7538 stats enable
7539 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
7540 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
7541 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
7542 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
7543
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007544 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
7545 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7546 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007547
7548
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007549stats auth <user>:<passwd>
7550 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
7551 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007552 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007553 Arguments :
7554 <user> is a user name to grant access to
7555
7556 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
7557
7558 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
7559 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
7560 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
7561 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
7562 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
7563 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
7564
7565 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
7566 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
7567 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007568 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007569
7570 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
7571 report using "stats scope".
7572
7573 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7574 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7575 unobvious parameters.
7576
7577 Example :
7578 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7579 backend public_www
7580 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7581 stats enable
7582 stats hide-version
7583 stats scope .
7584 stats uri /admin?stats
7585 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7586 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7587 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7588
7589 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7590 backend private_monitoring
7591 stats enable
7592 stats uri /admin?stats
7593 stats refresh 5s
7594
7595 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
7596
7597
7598stats enable
7599 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
7600 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007601 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007602 Arguments : none
7603
7604 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
7605 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
7606 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
7607 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
7608 - stats auth : no authentication
7609 - stats scope : no restriction
7610
7611 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7612 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7613 unobvious parameters.
7614
7615 Example :
7616 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7617 backend public_www
7618 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7619 stats enable
7620 stats hide-version
7621 stats scope .
7622 stats uri /admin?stats
7623 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7624 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7625 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7626
7627 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7628 backend private_monitoring
7629 stats enable
7630 stats uri /admin?stats
7631 stats refresh 5s
7632
7633 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7634
7635
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007636stats hide-version
7637 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007638 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007639 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007640 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007641
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007642 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
7643 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
7644 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
7645 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
7646 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
7647 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007648
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007649 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7650 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7651 unobvious parameters.
7652
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007653 Example :
7654 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7655 backend public_www
7656 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007657 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007658 stats hide-version
7659 stats scope .
7660 stats uri /admin?stats
7661 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7662 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7663 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007664
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007665 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7666 backend private_monitoring
7667 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007668 stats uri /admin?stats
7669 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01007670
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007671 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007672
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01007673
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02007674stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
7675 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7676 Access control for statistics
7677
7678 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7679 no | no | yes | yes
7680
7681 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
7682 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
7683 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
7684 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
7685 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
7686 should be asked to enter a username and password.
7687
7688 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
7689 instance.
7690
7691 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
7692 about ACL usage.
7693
7694
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007695stats realm <realm>
7696 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
7697 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007698 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007699 Arguments :
7700 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
7701 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
7702 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
7703
7704 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
7705 using a backslash ('\').
7706
7707 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
7708 only related to authentication.
7709
7710 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7711 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7712 unobvious parameters.
7713
7714 Example :
7715 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7716 backend public_www
7717 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7718 stats enable
7719 stats hide-version
7720 stats scope .
7721 stats uri /admin?stats
7722 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7723 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7724 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7725
7726 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7727 backend private_monitoring
7728 stats enable
7729 stats uri /admin?stats
7730 stats refresh 5s
7731
7732 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
7733
7734
7735stats refresh <delay>
7736 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
7737 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007738 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007739 Arguments :
7740 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
7741 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
7742 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
7743 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
7744 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
7745 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
7746
7747 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
7748 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
7749 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
7750 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
7751
7752 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7753 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7754 unobvious parameters.
7755
7756 Example :
7757 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7758 backend public_www
7759 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7760 stats enable
7761 stats hide-version
7762 stats scope .
7763 stats uri /admin?stats
7764 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7765 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7766 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7767
7768 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7769 backend private_monitoring
7770 stats enable
7771 stats uri /admin?stats
7772 stats refresh 5s
7773
7774 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7775
7776
7777stats scope { <name> | "." }
7778 Enable statistics and limit access scope
7779 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007780 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007781 Arguments :
7782 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
7783 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
7784 section in which the statement appears.
7785
7786 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
7787 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
7788 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
7789 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
7790 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
7791 exists.
7792
7793 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7794 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7795 unobvious parameters.
7796
7797 Example :
7798 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7799 backend public_www
7800 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7801 stats enable
7802 stats hide-version
7803 stats scope .
7804 stats uri /admin?stats
7805 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7806 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7807 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7808
7809 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7810 backend private_monitoring
7811 stats enable
7812 stats uri /admin?stats
7813 stats refresh 5s
7814
7815 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7816
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007817
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007818stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007819 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
7820 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007821 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007822
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007823 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007824 description from global section is automatically used instead.
7825
7826 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
7827 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
7828
7829 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7830 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007831 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007832
7833 Example :
7834 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7835 backend private_monitoring
7836 stats enable
7837 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
7838 stats uri /admin?stats
7839 stats refresh 5s
7840
7841 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
7842 global section.
7843
7844
7845stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007846 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
7847 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7848 yes | yes | yes | yes
7849 Arguments : none
7850
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007851 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007852 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
7853 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
7854 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
7855 - IP (socket, server)
7856 - cookie (backend, server)
7857
7858 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7859 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007860 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007861
7862 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
7863
7864
7865stats show-node [ <name> ]
7866 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
7867 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007868 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007869 Arguments:
7870 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
7871 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
7872
7873 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
7874 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007875 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007876
7877 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7878 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7879 unobvious parameters.
7880
7881 Example:
7882 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7883 backend private_monitoring
7884 stats enable
7885 stats show-node Europe-1
7886 stats uri /admin?stats
7887 stats refresh 5s
7888
7889 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
7890 section.
7891
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007892
7893stats uri <prefix>
7894 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
7895 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007896 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007897 Arguments :
7898 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
7899 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
7900 query string.
7901
7902 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
7903 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
7904 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
7905 possible to reach it in the application.
7906
7907 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007908 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007909 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
7910 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
7911 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
7912 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
7913
7914 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
7915 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
7916 an address or a port to statistics only.
7917
7918 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7919 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7920 unobvious parameters.
7921
7922 Example :
7923 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7924 backend public_www
7925 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7926 stats enable
7927 stats hide-version
7928 stats scope .
7929 stats uri /admin?stats
7930 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7931 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7932 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7933
7934 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7935 backend private_monitoring
7936 stats enable
7937 stats uri /admin?stats
7938 stats refresh 5s
7939
7940 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
7941
7942
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007943stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
7944 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007945 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007946 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007947
7948 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007949 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007950 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
7951 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
7952 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
7953
7954 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7955 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7956 the "stick-table" statement.
7957
7958 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
7959 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
7960 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
7961 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
7962 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
7963
7964 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7965 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
7966 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
7967 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
7968 transformation rules.
7969
7970 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7971 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7972 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7973 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7974 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7975 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7976 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7977
7978 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
7979 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
7980 ACL based conditions.
7981
7982 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
7983 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
7984 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
7985 matches can be used as fallbacks.
7986
7987 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
7988 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
7989 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
7990 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
7991
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007992 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7993 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7994 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7995
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007996 Example :
7997 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
7998 # last 30 minutes
7999 backend pop
8000 mode tcp
8001 balance roundrobin
8002 stick store-request src
8003 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8004 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8005 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8006
8007 backend smtp
8008 mode tcp
8009 balance roundrobin
8010 stick match src table pop
8011 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8012 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8013
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008014 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008015 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008016
8017
8018stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8019 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8020 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8021 no | no | yes | yes
8022
8023 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8024 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8025 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8026 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8027
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008028 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8029 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8030 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8031
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008032 Examples :
8033 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008034 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008035
8036 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8037 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8038 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8039
8040
8041 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8042 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8043 backend http
8044 mode http
8045 balance roundrobin
8046 stick on src table https
8047 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8048 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8049 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8050
8051 backend https
8052 mode tcp
8053 balance roundrobin
8054 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8055 stick on src
8056 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8057 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8058
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008059 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008060
8061
8062stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8063 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8064 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8065 no | no | yes | yes
8066
8067 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008068 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008069 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
8070 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8071 server is selected.
8072
8073 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8074 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8075 the "stick-table" statement.
8076
8077 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8078 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8079 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8080 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8081 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8082 address.
8083
8084 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8085 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8086 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8087 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8088 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8089 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8090 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8091 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8092 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8093 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8094
8095 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8096 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8097 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8098 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8099 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8100 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8101 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8102
8103 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8104 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8105 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8106 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8107
8108 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8109 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8110 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8111 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8112 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8113 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008114 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8115 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8116 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8117 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8118 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8119 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008120
8121 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8122 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8123 the request.
8124
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008125 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8126 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8127 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8128
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008129 Example :
8130 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8131 # last 30 minutes
8132 backend pop
8133 mode tcp
8134 balance roundrobin
8135 stick store-request src
8136 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8137 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8138 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8139
8140 backend smtp
8141 mode tcp
8142 balance roundrobin
8143 stick match src table pop
8144 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8145 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8146
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008147 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008148 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008149
8150
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008151stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008152 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8153 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008154 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008155 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008156 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008157
8158 Arguments :
8159 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8160 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8161 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8162 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8163
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008164 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8165 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8166 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8167 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8168
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008169 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8170 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8171 instance.
8172
8173 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8174 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8175 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8176 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8177 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8178 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008179 to 32 characters.
8180
8181 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8182 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8183 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008184 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008185 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8186 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008187
8188 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008189 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8190 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008191 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8192 increase.
8193
8194 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008195 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
8196 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
8197 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008198
8199 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8200 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8201 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8202 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
8203 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
8204 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8205 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8206 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8207 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8208 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8209 parameter (see below).
8210
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008211 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8212 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8213 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8214 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8215 soft restart.
8216
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008217 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8218 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008219
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008220 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8221 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
8222 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
8223 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
8224 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008225 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008226 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
8227 if not expiration delay is specified.
8228
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008229 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
8230 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
8231 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
8232 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008233 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
8234 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
8235 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
8236 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
8237 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
8238 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
8239 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
8240 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
8241 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
8242 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
8243 types and their arguments.
8244
8245 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
8246 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
8247 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
8248 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
8249
8250 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8251 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8252 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
8253 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
8254
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008255 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
8256 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8257 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
8258 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
8259 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
8260 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
8261
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008262 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8263 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
8264 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
8265 they were received.
8266
8267 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8268 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
8269 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
8270 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
8271 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
8272
8273 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8274 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8275 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8276 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
8277 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8278
8279 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8280 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
8281 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
8282
8283 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8284 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8285 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8286 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
8287 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8288
8289 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8290 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
8291 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
8292 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
8293 the client side.
8294
8295 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8296 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8297 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8298 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
8299 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
8300 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
8301 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
8302
8303 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8304 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
8305 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
8306 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
8307 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
8308 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
8309 (eg: vulnerability scan).
8310
8311 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8312 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8313 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8314 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
8315 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
8316 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8317
8318 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8319 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
8320 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
8321 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
8322
8323 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8324 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8325 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8326 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8327 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8328 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
8329 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
8330 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
8331 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
8332 recommended for better fairness.
8333
8334 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8335 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
8336 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
8337 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
8338
8339 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
8340 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8341 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8342 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8343 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8344 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
8345 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
8346 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
8347 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
8348 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008349
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008350 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
8351 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008352 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
8353 reference it.
8354
8355 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
8356 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01008357 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
8358 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
8359 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008360
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008361 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
8362 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
8363 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
8364 something that can be ignored.
8365
8366 Example:
8367 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
8368 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
8369 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
8370 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
8371
8372 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01008373 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008374
8375
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008376stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01008377 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008378 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8379 no | no | yes | yes
8380
8381 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008382 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008383 describes what elements of the response or connection will
8384 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8385 server is selected.
8386
8387 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8388 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8389 the "stick-table" statement.
8390
8391 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8392 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8393 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
8394 when the response is a SSL server hello.
8395
8396 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8397 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
8398 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
8399 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
8400 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
8401 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008402 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008403 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
8404 rules.
8405
8406 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8407 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8408 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8409 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8410 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8411 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8412 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8413
8414 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
8415 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8416 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
8417 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8418
8419 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
8420 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8421 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8422 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8423 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8424 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008425 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
8426 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8427 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8428 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8429 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8430 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
8431 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
8432 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
8433 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008434
8435 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
8436
8437 Example :
8438 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
8439 backend https
8440 mode tcp
8441 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008442 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008443 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008444
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008445 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
8446 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
8447
8448 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
8449 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8450 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
8451
8452 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
8453 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008454
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008455 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
8456 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
8457 # at offset 44.
8458
8459 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
8460 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
8461
8462 # Learn on response if server hello.
8463 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008464
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008465 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8466 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8467
8468 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
8469 extraction.
8470
8471
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008472tcp-check connect [params*]
8473 Opens a new connection
8474 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8475 no | no | yes | yes
8476
8477 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
8478 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
8479 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
8480
8481 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
8482 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
8483 of the sequence.
8484
8485 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
8486 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
8487 do.
8488
8489 Parameters :
8490 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
8491 use the TCP connection.
8492
8493 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
8494 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
8495 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
8496
8497 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
8498
8499 ssl opens a ciphered connection
8500
8501 Examples:
8502 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
8503 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
8504 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
8505 option tcp-check
8506 tcp-check connect
8507 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8508 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8509 tcp-check send \r\n
8510 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8511 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
8512 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8513 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8514 tcp-check send \r\n
8515 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8516 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
8517
8518 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
8519 option tcp-check
8520 tcp-check connect port 110
8521 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8522 tcp-check connect port 143
8523 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8524 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
8525
8526 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
8527
8528
8529tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
8530 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
8531 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8532 no | no | yes | yes
8533
8534 Arguments :
8535 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
8536 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
8537 binary.
8538 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
8539 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
8540 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
8541
8542 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
8543 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
8544 with the usual backslash ('\').
8545 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
8546 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
8547 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
8548 used upper or lower case.
8549
8550
8551 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
8552
8553 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
8554 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8555 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
8556 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8557 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
8558 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
8559 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
8560 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
8561
8562 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
8563 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8564 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
8565 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8566 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
8567 expression.
8568
8569 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
8570 in the response buffer. A health check response will
8571 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
8572 this exact hexadecimal string.
8573 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
8574
8575 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
8576 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
8577 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
8578 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
8579 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
8580 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
8581 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
8582 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
8583 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
8584 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
8585 the null character.
8586
8587 Examples :
8588 # perform a POP check
8589 option tcp-check
8590 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8591
8592 # perform an IMAP check
8593 option tcp-check
8594 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8595
8596 # look for the redis master server
8597 option tcp-check
8598 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008599 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008600 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8601 tcp-check expect string role:master
8602 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8603 tcp-check expect string +OK
8604
8605
8606 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
8607 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
8608
8609
8610tcp-check send <data>
8611 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8612 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8613 no | no | yes | yes
8614
8615 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8616 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8617
8618 Examples :
8619 # look for the redis master server
8620 option tcp-check
8621 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8622 tcp-check expect string role:master
8623
8624 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8625 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
8626
8627
8628tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
8629 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
8630 tcp health check
8631 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8632 no | no | yes | yes
8633
8634 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8635 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8636 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
8637 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
8638 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
8639 hexadecimal string.
8640 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
8641
8642 Examples :
8643 # redis check in binary
8644 option tcp-check
8645 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
8646 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
8647
8648
8649 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8650 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
8651
8652
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008653tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8654 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008655 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8656 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008657 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02008658 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
8659 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008660
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008661 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008662
8663 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
8664 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008665 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
8666 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
8667 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
8668 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
8669 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
8670 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008671
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008672 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
8673 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
8674 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
8675 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008676
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008677 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008678 - accept :
8679 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8680 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8681 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008682
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008683 - reject :
8684 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8685 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8686 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
8687 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
8688 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
8689 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
8690 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
8691 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
8692 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
8693 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
8694 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02008695 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008696
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008697 - expect-proxy layer4 :
8698 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
8699 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
8700 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
8701 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
8702 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
8703 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
8704 hosts.
8705
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01008706 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
8707 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
8708 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
8709 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
8710 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
8711 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
8712 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
8713 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
8714
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008715 - capture <sample> len <length> :
8716 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
8717 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
8718 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
8719 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
8720 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
8721 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
8722 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
8723 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008724 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
8725 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008726
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008727 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008728 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02008729 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008730 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008731 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
8732 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008733 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008734 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
8735 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
8736 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
8737 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
8738 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008739
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008740 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008741 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008742 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008743 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
8744 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
8745 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
8746 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008747
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008748 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
8749 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
8750 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
8751 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008752
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008753 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
8754 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
8755 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
8756 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
8757 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008758 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
8759 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
8760 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
8761 layer7 information is extracted.
8762
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008763 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
8764 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
8765 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
8766 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
8767 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008768
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02008769 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
8770 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
8771 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
8772 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
8773
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008774 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
8775 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
8776 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
8777 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
8778 continues.
8779
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02008780 - set-src <expr> :
8781 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
8782 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
8783 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
8784 set-src"
8785
8786 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8787 followed by some converters.
8788
8789 Example:
8790
8791 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
8792
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02008793 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
8794 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02008795
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02008796 - set-src-port <expr> :
8797 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
8798 expression.
8799
8800 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8801 followed by some converters.
8802
8803 Example:
8804
8805 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
8806
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02008807 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
8808 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
8809 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02008810
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02008811 - set-dst <expr> :
8812 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
8813 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
8814 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
8815 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
8816 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
8817
8818 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8819 followed by some converters.
8820
8821 Example:
8822
8823 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
8824 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
8825
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02008826 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
8827 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
8828
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02008829 - set-dst-port <expr> :
8830 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
8831 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
8832 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
8833
8834
8835 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8836 followed by some converters.
8837
8838 Example:
8839
8840 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
8841
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02008842 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
8843 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
8844 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
8845
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02008846 - "silent-drop" :
8847 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
8848 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
8849 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
8850 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
8851 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
8852 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
8853 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
8854 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
8855 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
8856 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
8857 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
8858 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
8859 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
8860 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
8861 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
8862 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
8863
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008864 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
8865 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8866 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008867
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008868 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
8869 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
8870 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008871
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008872 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008873 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008874 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008875
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008876 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
8877 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
8878 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008879
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008880 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008881 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
8882 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008883
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008884 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
8885
8886 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
8887
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008888 See section 7 about ACL usage.
8889
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02008890 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008891
8892
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008893tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8894 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008895 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008896 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008897 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02008898 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
8899 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008900
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008901 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008902
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008903 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
8904 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
8905 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
8906 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
8907 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008908
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008909 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
8910 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
8911 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
8912 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008913 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
8914 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
8915 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
8916 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
8917 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
8918 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008919 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008920 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008921
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008922 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
8923 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
8924 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
8925 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008926
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008927 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008928 - accept : the request is accepted
8929 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
8930 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008931 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02008932 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02008933 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008934 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02008935 - silent-drop
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008936
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008937 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
8938 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008939
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008940 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
8941 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
8942 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
8943 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
8944 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
8945 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008946
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008947 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008948 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8949 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008950
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008951 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02008952 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
8953 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
8954 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
8955 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008956 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
8957 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
8958 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008959
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008960 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008961 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
8962 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
8963 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008964
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008965 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02008966 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
8967 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008968
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01008969 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
8970 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
8971 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
8972 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008973 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01008974 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008975 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01008976 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
8977 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008978 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01008979 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
8980 and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008981
8982 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8983 followed by some converters.
8984
8985 Example:
8986
8987 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
8988
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008989 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008990 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
8991 # and reject everything else.
8992 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
8993 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02008994 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008995 tcp-request content reject
8996
8997 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008998 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
8999 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9000 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009001 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009002
9003 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9004 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9005 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009006 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009007 tcp-request content reject
9008
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009009 Example:
9010 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
9011 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009012 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009013
9014 Example:
9015 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9016 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009017 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009018
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009019 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
9020 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
9021
9022 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009023 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009024 # protecting all our sites
9025 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009026 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9027 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009028 ...
9029 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9030
9031 backend http_dynamic
9032 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009033 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009034 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009035 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
9036 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
9037 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009038 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009039
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009040 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009041
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009042 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session", and
9043 "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009044
9045
9046tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9047 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9048 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009049 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009050 Arguments :
9051 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9052 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9053 as explained at the top of this document.
9054
9055 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9056 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9057 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9058 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9059 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9060
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009061 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9062 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9063 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9064 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9065
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009066 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9067 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009068 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009069 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009070 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9071 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9072 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9073 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009074
9075 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9076 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9077 it pass through unaffected.
9078
9079 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9080 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9081 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009082 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009083 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9084 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009085 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9086 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9087 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009088
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009089 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009090 "timeout client".
9091
9092
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009093tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9094 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9095 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9096 no | no | yes | yes
9097 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009098 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9099 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009100
9101 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9102
9103 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
9104 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9105 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009106 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9107 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009108
9109 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9110
9111 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9112 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9113 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9114 inserted.
9115
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009116 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009117 - accept :
9118 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9119 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9120 the rules evaluation.
9121
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009122 - close :
9123 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
9124 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
9125 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
9126 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
9127 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
9128 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009129 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009130 protocols.
9131
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009132 - reject :
9133 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9134 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009135 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009136
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009137 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9138 Sets a variable.
9139
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009140 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9141 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9142 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9143 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9144
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009145 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
9146 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9147 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9148 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9149 continues.
9150
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009151 - "silent-drop" :
9152 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
9153 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
9154 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9155 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9156 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9157 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9158 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
9159 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
9160 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
9161 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9162 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
9163 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
9164 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9165 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9166 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9167 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9168
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009169 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9170 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9171 for changing the default action to a reject.
9172
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009173 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
9174 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
9175 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
9176 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009177 period.
9178
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009179 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
9180 declared inline.
9181
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009182 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9183 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
9184 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9185 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009186 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009187 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009188 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009189 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9190 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009191 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009192 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
9193 and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009194
9195 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9196 followed by some converters.
9197
9198 Example:
9199
9200 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
9201
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009202 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9203
9204 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
9205
9206
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009207tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9208 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
9209 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9210 no | yes | yes | no
9211 Arguments :
9212 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9213 below.
9214
9215 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9216
9217 Once a session is validated, (ie. after all handshakes have been completed),
9218 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
9219 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
9220 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
9221 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
9222 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
9223 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
9224 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
9225 from the PROXY protocol header (eg: track a source forwarded this way). The
9226 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
9227 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
9228 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
9229 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
9230 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
9231 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
9232 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
9233 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
9234 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
9235 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
9236 instead.
9237
9238 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9239 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9240 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
9241 rules which may be inserted.
9242
9243 Several types of actions are supported :
9244 - accept : the request is accepted
9245 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9246 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
9247 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
9248 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
9249 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9250 - silent-drop
9251
9252 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
9253 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
9254 sections for a complete description.
9255
9256 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9257 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9258 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
9259
9260 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
9261 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
9262 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
9263 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
9264 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
9265
9266 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9267 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9268
9269 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9270 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
9271 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
9272
9273 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9274 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
9275 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9276
9277 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
9278 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9279 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
9280
9281 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9282 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9283 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
9284
9285 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9286
9287 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
9288
9289
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009290tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
9291 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
9292 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9293 no | no | yes | yes
9294 Arguments :
9295 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9296 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9297 as explained at the top of this document.
9298
9299 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
9300
9301
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009302timeout check <timeout>
9303 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
9304 established.
9305
9306 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9307 yes | no | yes | yes
9308 Arguments:
9309 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9310 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9311 as explained at the top of this document.
9312
9313 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
9314 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
9315 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
9316 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01009317 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
9318 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
9319 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009320
9321 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
9322 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
9323
9324 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
9325 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009326 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009327
9328 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9329 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9330 forget about it.
9331
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009332 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
9333 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009334
9335
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009336timeout client <timeout>
9337timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9338 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
9339 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9340 yes | yes | yes | no
9341 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009342 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009343 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9344 as explained at the top of this document.
9345
9346 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9347 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9348 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009349 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
9350 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
9351 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
9352 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009353 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
9354 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
9355 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009356 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009357 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009358 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
9359 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009360 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
9361 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009362
9363 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9364 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9365 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9366 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9367 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9368 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9369
9370 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
9371 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
9372 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9373
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009374 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
9375 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009376
9377
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009378timeout client-fin <timeout>
9379 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
9380 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9381 yes | yes | yes | no
9382 Arguments :
9383 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9384 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9385 as explained at the top of this document.
9386
9387 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9388 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9389 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9390 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9391 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
9392 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9393 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9394 down in one direction.
9395
9396 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9397 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9398 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
9399
9400 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
9401
9402
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009403timeout connect <timeout>
9404timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9405 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
9406 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9407 yes | no | yes | yes
9408 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009409 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009410 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9411 as explained at the top of this document.
9412
9413 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009414 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009415 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009416 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009417 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
9418 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009419
9420 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9421 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9422 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9423 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9424 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
9425 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9426
9427 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
9428 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
9429 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9430
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009431 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
9432 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009433
9434
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009435timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
9436 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
9437 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9438 yes | yes | yes | yes
9439 Arguments :
9440 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9441 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9442 as explained at the top of this document.
9443
9444 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
9445 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
9446 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
9447 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
9448 once the request has started to present itself.
9449
9450 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
9451 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
9452 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
9453 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
9454 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
9455
9456 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
9457 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
9458 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
9459 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
9460
9461 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
9462 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
9463 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
9464 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
9465 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02009466 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009467
9468 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
9469 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
9470 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
9471 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
9472
9473 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
9474
9475
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009476timeout http-request <timeout>
9477 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
9478 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009479 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009480 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009481 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009482 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9483 as explained at the top of this document.
9484
9485 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
9486 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
9487 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
9488 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
9489 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
9490 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
9491 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02009492 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
9493 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
9494 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
9495 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
9496 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009497 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
9498 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009499
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009500 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
9501 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
9502 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
9503 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
9504 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009505 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009506
9507 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
9508 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
9509 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
9510 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
9511 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
9512
9513 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009514 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
9515 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
9516 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009517
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009518 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009519 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009520
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009521
9522timeout queue <timeout>
9523 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
9524 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9525 yes | no | yes | yes
9526 Arguments :
9527 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9528 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9529 as explained at the top of this document.
9530
9531 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
9532 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
9533 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
9534 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
9535 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
9536
9537 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
9538 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
9539 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
9540 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
9541
9542 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9543
9544
9545timeout server <timeout>
9546timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9547 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
9548 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9549 yes | no | yes | yes
9550 Arguments :
9551 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9552 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9553 as explained at the top of this document.
9554
9555 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9556 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9557 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
9558 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
9559 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
9560 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
9561 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
9562
9563 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9564 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9565 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
9566 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
9567 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009568 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009569 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009570 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
9571 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
9572 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
9573 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009574
9575 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9576 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9577 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9578 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9579 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9580 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9581
9582 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
9583 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
9584 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9585
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009586 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009587
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009588
9589timeout server-fin <timeout>
9590 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
9591 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9592 yes | no | yes | yes
9593 Arguments :
9594 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9595 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9596 as explained at the top of this document.
9597
9598 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9599 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9600 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9601 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9602 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
9603 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9604 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9605 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
9606 situations, it should not be needed.
9607
9608 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9609 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9610 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
9611
9612 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
9613
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009614
9615timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009616 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009617 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9618 yes | yes | yes | yes
9619 Arguments :
9620 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
9621 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9622 as explained at the top of this document.
9623
9624 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
9625 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
9626 defines how long it will be maintained open.
9627
9628 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9629 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9630 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
9631 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009632 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009633
9634 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9635
9636
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009637timeout tunnel <timeout>
9638 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
9639 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9640 yes | no | yes | yes
9641 Arguments :
9642 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9643 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9644 as explained at the top of this document.
9645
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009646 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009647 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
9648 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
9649 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
9650 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
9651 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
9652 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
9653 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
9654 specified.
9655
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009656 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
9657 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
9658 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
9659 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
9660 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
9661 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
9662 state.
9663
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009664 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9665 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9666 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
9667 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
9668 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
9669
9670 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9671 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9672 forget about it.
9673
9674 Example :
9675 defaults http
9676 option http-server-close
9677 timeout connect 5s
9678 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009679 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009680 timeout server 30s
9681 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
9682
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009683 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009684
9685
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009686transparent (deprecated)
9687 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9688 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009689 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009690 Arguments : none
9691
9692 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
9693 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9694 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9695 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9696 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9697 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9698 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9699 appropriate server.
9700
9701 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
9702
9703 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9704 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9705
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009706 See also: "option transparent"
9707
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009708unique-id-format <string>
9709 Generate a unique ID for each request.
9710 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9711 yes | yes | yes | no
9712 Arguments :
9713 <string> is a log-format string.
9714
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009715 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
9716 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
9717 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
9718 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009719
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009720 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
9721 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
9722 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
9723 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
9724 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
9725 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
9726 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
9727 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009728
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009729 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
9730 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009731
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009732 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009733
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05009734 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009735
9736 will generate:
9737
9738 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
9739
9740 See also: "unique-id-header"
9741
9742unique-id-header <name>
9743 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
9744 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9745 yes | yes | yes | no
9746 Arguments :
9747 <name> is the name of the header.
9748
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009749 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
9750 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009751
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009752 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009753
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05009754 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009755 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
9756
9757 will generate:
9758
9759 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
9760
9761 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009762
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02009763use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02009764 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009765 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9766 no | yes | yes | no
9767 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009768 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
9769 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009770
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02009771 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
9772 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009773
9774 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
9775 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
9776 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02009777 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
9778 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
9779 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
9780 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009781
9782 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
9783 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
9784 assign the backend.
9785
9786 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
9787 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
9788 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
9789 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
9790 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
9791 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
9792
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02009793 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009794 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02009795 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
9796 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
9797 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
9798
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009799 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
9800 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
9801 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
9802 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
9803 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
9804 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
9805 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
9806 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
9807 cannot be forced from the request.
9808
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009809 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009810 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
9811 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
9812
9813 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
9814 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009815
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009816
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009817use-server <server> if <condition>
9818use-server <server> unless <condition>
9819 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
9820 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9821 no | no | yes | yes
9822 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009823 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009824
9825 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
9826
9827 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
9828 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
9829 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
9830
9831 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
9832 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
9833 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
9834 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
9835 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
9836 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
9837 matches will assign the server.
9838
9839 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
9840 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
9841 with the next rules until one matches.
9842
9843 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
9844 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
9845 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
9846 according to other persistence mechanisms.
9847
9848 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
9849 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
9850 stripped.
9851
9852 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
9853 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
9854 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
9855 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
9856
9857 Example :
9858 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
9859 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
9860 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
9861 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
9862 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
9863 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
9864 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
9865 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
9866 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
9867
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009868 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009869
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009870
98715. Bind and Server options
9872--------------------------
9873
9874The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
9875depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
9876settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
9877written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
9878described in this section.
9879
9880
98815.1. Bind options
9882-----------------
9883
9884The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
9885as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
9886no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
9887parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
9888while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
9889provided immediately after the setting name.
9890
9891The currently supported settings are the following ones.
9892
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +01009893accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
9894 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
9895 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
9896 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
9897 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
9898 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
9899 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
9900 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
9901 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
9902 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009903 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
9904 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
9905 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +01009906
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009907accept-proxy
9908 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +02009909 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
9910 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009911 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
9912 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
9913 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
9914 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
9915 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
9916 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
9917 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009918 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
9919 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009920
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02009921alpn <protocols>
9922 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
9923 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
9924 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
9925 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
9926 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
9927 initial NPN extension.
9928
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009929backlog <backlog>
9930 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
9931 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
9932
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02009933ecdhe <named curve>
9934 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01009935 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
9936 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02009937
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009938ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009939 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9940 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
9941 client's certificate.
9942
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009943ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
9944 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
9945 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
9946 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
9947 error is ignored.
9948
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02009949ca-sign-file <cafile>
9950 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9951 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
9952 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
9953 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
9954 'generate-certificates' for details.
9955
9956ca-sign-passphrase <passphrase>
9957 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
9958 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
9959 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
9960 'generate-certificates' for details.
9961
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009962ciphers <ciphers>
9963 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
9964 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009965 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009966 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
9967 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
9968
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009969crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009970 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9971 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
9972 to verify client's certificate.
9973
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009974crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009975 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9976 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
9977 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
9978 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
9979 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
9980 file.
9981
9982 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
9983 are loaded.
9984
9985 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01009986 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +01009987 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
9988 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
9989 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
9990 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
9991 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
9992 instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
9993 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009994
9995 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
9996 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
9997 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
9998 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01009999 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10000 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010001
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010002 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010003
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010004 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
10005 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +080010006 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010007 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
10008 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10009 clients).
10010
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010011 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10012 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10013 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10014 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10015 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10016 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10017 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10018 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10019 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10020 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10021 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
10022 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
10023 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
10024
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010025 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
10026 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
10027 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
10028 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
10029 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
10030
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010031 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
10032 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
10033 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
10034 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010035
10036 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
10037 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
10038 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
10039 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
10040 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
10041 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
10042 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
10043 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
10044 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
10045
10046 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
10047
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010048 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010049 a cert bundle.
10050
10051 Haproxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
10052 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
10053 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
10054 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
10055 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
10056 provide multi-cert support.
10057
10058 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
10059
10060 Filename | CN | SAN
10061 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10062 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010063 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010064 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
10065 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10066
10067 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
10068 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
10069 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
10070 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
10071 suites.
10072
10073 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
10074 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
10075
10076 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
10077 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
10078 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
10079
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010080crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010081 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
10082 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010083 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010084 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010085
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010086crt-list <file>
10087 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020010088 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
10089 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010090
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020010091 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010092
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020010093 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
10094 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
10095 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
10096 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
10097 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
10098 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
10099 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
10100 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010101
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010102 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020010103 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
10104 all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010105
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010106defer-accept
10107 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10108 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
10109 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
10110 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
10111 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
10112 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
10113 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
10114 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
10115 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
10116 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
10117 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
10118
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010119force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010120 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010121 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010122 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
10123 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010124
10125force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010126 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010127 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10128 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010129
10130force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010131 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010132 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10133 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010134
10135force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010136 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010137 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10138 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010139
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010140generate-certificates
10141 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10142 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
10143 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
10144 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
10145 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
10146 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
10147 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
10148 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
10149 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
10150 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
10151 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
10152
10153 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
10154 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
10155 increases the HAProxy's memroy footprint to reduce latency when the same
10156 certificate is used many times.
10157
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010158gid <gid>
10159 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
10160 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10161 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
10162 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
10163 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10164
10165group <group>
10166 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
10167 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
10168 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
10169 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
10170 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10171
10172id <id>
10173 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
10174 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
10175 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
10176 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
10177
10178interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010010179 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
10180 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
10181 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
10182 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
10183 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
10184 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
10185 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010186
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010187level <level>
10188 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
10189 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
10190 sockets. <level> can be one of :
10191 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
10192 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
10193 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
10194 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
10195 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
10196 counters).
10197 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
10198 all counters).
10199
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010200maxconn <maxconn>
10201 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
10202 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
10203 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
10204 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
10205 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
10206 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
10207 eat all memory.
10208
10209mode <mode>
10210 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
10211 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
10212 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
10213 UNIX sockets.
10214
10215mss <maxseg>
10216 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
10217 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
10218 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
10219 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
10220 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
10221 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
10222 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
10223 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
10224 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
10225 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
10226 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
10227
10228name <name>
10229 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
10230 page.
10231
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010232namespace <name>
10233 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
10234 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
10235 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
10236 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
10237
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010238nice <nice>
10239 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
10240 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
10241 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
10242 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
10243 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
10244 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
10245 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
10246 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
10247 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
10248 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
10249 one for an RDP socket.
10250
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010251no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010252 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010253 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010254 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010255 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
10256 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "force-tls*",
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010257 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010258
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010259no-tls-tickets
10260 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10261 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
10262 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010263 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
10264 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010265
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010266no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010267 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010268 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010269 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010270 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10271 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10272 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010273
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010274no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010275 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010276 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010277 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010278 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10279 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10280 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010281
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010282no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010283 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010284 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010285 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010286 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10287 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10288 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010289
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010290npn <protocols>
10291 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
10292 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
10293 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10294 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010295 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
10296 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010297
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010298process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
10299 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
10300 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
10301 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
10302 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
10303 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
10304 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
10305 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +020010306 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
10307 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
10308 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
10309 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
10310 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
10311 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
10312 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010313
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010314ssl
10315 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010316 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010317 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
10318 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
10319 to deciphered contents.
10320
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010010321strict-sni
10322 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
10323 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
10324 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
10325 See the "crt" option for more information.
10326
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010327tcp-ut <delay>
10328 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instanciated from this
10329 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
10330 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
10331 receiving an acknoledgement for the configured delay. This is especially
10332 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
10333 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
10334 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
10335 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
10336 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
10337 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
10338 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
10339
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010340tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010010341 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010342 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
10343 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
10344 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
10345 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
10346 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
10347 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
10348 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020010349 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
10350 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
10351 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010352
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010010353tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
10354 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
10355 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
10356 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
10357 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
10358 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
10359 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
10360 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
10361 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
10362 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
10363 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
10364
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010365transparent
10366 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10367 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
10368 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
10369 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
10370 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
10371 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
10372 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
10373 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
10374 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
10375 so check for support with your vendor.
10376
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010377v4v6
10378 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10379 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
10380 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
10381 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010382 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010383
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010384v6only
10385 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10386 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
10387 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010388 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
10389 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010390
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010391uid <uid>
10392 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
10393 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10394 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
10395 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
10396 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10397
10398user <user>
10399 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
10400 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10401 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
10402 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
10403 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10404
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010405verify [none|optional|required]
10406 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
10407 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
10408 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
10409 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
10410 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010411 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
10412 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
10413 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
10414 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010415
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200104165.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010010417------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010418
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010419The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
10420which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
10421arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
10422settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
10423after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
10424Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
10425address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010426
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010427 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010428 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010429
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010430The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010431
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020010432addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010433 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010010434 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
10435 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
10436 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
10437 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
10438 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010439
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010440 Supported in default-server: No
10441
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010442agent-check
10443 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010444 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
10445 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
10446 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
10447 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010448
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010449 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010450 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020010451 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
10452 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
10453 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010454
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020010455 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values in
10456 this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
10457 connections advertised needs to be multipled by the number of load balancers
10458 and different backends that use this health check to get the total number
10459 of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
10460
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010461 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10462 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010463
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010464 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10465 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
10466 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010467
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010468 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10469 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
10470 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010471
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010472 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
10473 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
10474 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
10475 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
10476 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
10477 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
10478 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010479
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010480 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
10481 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010482
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010483 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
10484 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
10485 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
10486 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
10487 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
10488 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
10489 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
10490 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
10491 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010492
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010493 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
10494 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010495 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
10496 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
10497 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010010498 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010499
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010500 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
10501 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010502
10503 Supported in default-server: No
10504
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070010505agent-send <string>
10506 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
10507 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
10508 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
10509 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
10510 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
10511
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010512agent-inter <delay>
10513 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
10514 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
10515
10516 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
10517 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
10518 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
10519 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
10520 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
10521 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
10522 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
10523 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
10524 of backends use the same servers.
10525
10526 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
10527
10528 Supported in default-server: Yes
10529
10530agent-port <port>
10531 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
10532
10533 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
10534
10535 Supported in default-server: Yes
10536
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010537backup
10538 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
10539 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
10540 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
10541 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
10542 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
10543 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010544
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010545 Supported in default-server: No
10546
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010547ca-file <cafile>
10548 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10549 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10550 server's certificate.
10551
10552 Supported in default-server: No
10553
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010554check
10555 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010010556 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
10557 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
10558 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
10559 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
10560 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
10561 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
10562 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090010563 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
10564 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
10565 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010566
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010567 Supported in default-server: No
10568
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020010569check-send-proxy
10570 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
10571 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
10572 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
10573 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
10574 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
10575 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
10576 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
10577
10578 Supported in default-server: No
10579
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010580check-ssl
10581 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
10582 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
10583 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
10584 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010585 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010586 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
10587 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
10588 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
10589 See the "ssl" option for more information.
10590
10591 Supported in default-server: No
10592
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010593ciphers <ciphers>
10594 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010595 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010596 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
10597 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
10598 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
10599 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
10600 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
10601 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
10602
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010603 Supported in default-server: No
10604
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010605cookie <value>
10606 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
10607 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
10608 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
10609 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
10610 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
10611 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
10612 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
10613
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010614 Supported in default-server: No
10615
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010616crl-file <crlfile>
10617 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10618 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10619 to verify server's certificate.
10620
10621 Supported in default-server: No
10622
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020010623crt <cert>
10624 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10625 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
10626 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
10627 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
10628 certificate request.
10629
10630 Supported in default-server: No
10631
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020010632disabled
10633 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
10634 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
10635 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
10636 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
10637 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
10638
10639 Supported in default-server: No
10640
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010641error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010642 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
10643 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
10644 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010645
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010646 Supported in default-server: Yes
10647
10648 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010649
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010650fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010651 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
10652 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
10653 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
10654
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010655 Supported in default-server: Yes
10656
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010657force-sslv3
10658 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
10659 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010660 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
10661 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010662
10663 Supported in default-server: No
10664
10665force-tlsv10
10666 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010667 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10668 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010669
10670 Supported in default-server: No
10671
10672force-tlsv11
10673 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010674 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10675 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010676
10677 Supported in default-server: No
10678
10679force-tlsv12
10680 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010681 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10682 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010683
10684 Supported in default-server: No
10685
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010686id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020010687 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
10688 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
10689 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010690
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010691 Supported in default-server: No
10692
10693inter <delay>
10694fastinter <delay>
10695downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010696 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
10697 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
10698 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
10699 between checks depending on the server state :
10700
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020010701 Server state | Interval used
10702 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10703 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
10704 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10705 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
10706 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
10707 or yet unchecked. |
10708 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10709 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
10710 | "inter" otherwise.
10711 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010712
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010713 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
10714 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
10715 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
10716 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010717 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
10718 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
10719 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
10720 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
10721 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010722
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010723 Supported in default-server: Yes
10724
10725maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010726 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
10727 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
10728 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
10729 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
10730 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
10731 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
10732 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
10733 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
10734
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010735 Supported in default-server: Yes
10736
10737maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010738 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
10739 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
10740 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
10741 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
10742 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
10743 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
10744 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
10745
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010746 Supported in default-server: Yes
10747
10748minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010749 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
10750 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
10751 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
10752 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
10753 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
10754 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010755 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010756 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010757
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010758 Supported in default-server: Yes
10759
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010760namespace <name>
10761 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
10762 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
10763 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
10764 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
10765
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010010766no-ssl-reuse
10767 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
10768 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
10769 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
10770 and for paranoid users.
10771
10772 Supported in default-server: No
10773
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010774no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010775 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
10776 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010777 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010778
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010779 Supported in default-server: No
10780
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020010781no-tls-tickets
10782 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10783 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
10784 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010785 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
10786 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020010787
10788 Supported in default-server: No
10789
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010790no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010791 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010792 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
10793 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010794 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
10795 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
10796 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010797
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010798 Supported in default-server: No
10799
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010800no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010801 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010802 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
10803 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010804 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
10805 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
10806 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010807
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010808 Supported in default-server: No
10809
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010810no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010811 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010812 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
10813 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010814 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
10815 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
10816 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010817
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010818 Supported in default-server: No
10819
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090010820non-stick
10821 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
10822 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
10823 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
10824
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010825 Supported in default-server: No
10826
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010827observe <mode>
10828 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
10829 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
10830 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
10831 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
10832 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
10833 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010010834 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010835
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010836 Supported in default-server: No
10837
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010838 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
10839
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010840on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010841 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
10842 Currently, four modes are available:
10843 - fastinter: force fastinter
10844 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
10845 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
10846 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
10847 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
10848
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010849 Supported in default-server: Yes
10850
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010851 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
10852
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090010853on-marked-down <action>
10854 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
10855 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070010856 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
10857 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
10858 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
10859 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
10860 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
10861 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
10862 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
10863 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090010864
10865 Actions are disabled by default
10866
10867 Supported in default-server: Yes
10868
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070010869on-marked-up <action>
10870 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
10871 Currently one action is available:
10872 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
10873 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
10874 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
10875 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
10876 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
10877 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
10878 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
10879 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
10880
10881 Actions are disabled by default
10882
10883 Supported in default-server: Yes
10884
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010885port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010886 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
10887 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
10888 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
10889 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
10890 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
10891 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
10892
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010893 Supported in default-server: Yes
10894
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010895redir <prefix>
10896 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
10897 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
10898 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
10899 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
10900 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
10901 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
10902 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
10903 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010904 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010905 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
10906 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
10907 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
10908 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
10909 loop between the client and HAProxy!
10910
10911 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
10912
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010913 Supported in default-server: No
10914
10915rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010916 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
10917 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
10918 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
10919
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010920 Supported in default-server: Yes
10921
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010922resolve-prefer <family>
10923 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
10924 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
10925 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
10926 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
10927
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020010928 Default value: ipv6
10929
10930 Supported in default-server: Yes
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010931
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020010932 Example:
10933
10934 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010935
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010010936resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
10937 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
10938 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
10939 avalailibility service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
10940 differents datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
10941 this patch permitsto prefers a local datacenter. If none address matchs the
10942 configured network, another address is selected.
10943
10944 Supported in default-server: Yes
10945
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020010946 Example:
10947
10948 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010010949
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010950resolvers <id>
10951 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
10952 hostname.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020010953 In order to be operational, DNS resolution requires that health check is
10954 enabled on the server. Actually, health checks triggers the DNS resolution.
10955 You must precise one 'resolvers' parameter on each server line where DNS
10956 resolution is required.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010957
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020010958 Supported in default-server: No
10959
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020010960 Example:
10961
10962 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010963
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020010964 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010965
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010010966send-proxy
10967 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
10968 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
10969 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
10970 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010971 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
10972 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
10973 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
10974 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
10975 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
10976 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
10977 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
10978 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
10979 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
10980 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
10981 See also the "accept-proxy" and "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind"
10982 keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010010983
10984 Supported in default-server: No
10985
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040010986send-proxy-v2
10987 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
10988 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
10989 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
10990 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
10991 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
10992 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
10993 option of the "bind" keyword.
10994
10995 Supported in default-server: No
10996
10997send-proxy-v2-ssl
10998 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
10999 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11000 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11001 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11002 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11003 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
11004 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
11005 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
11006
11007 Supported in default-server: No
11008
11009send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11010 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11011 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11012 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11013 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11014 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11015 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
11016 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
11017 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
11018 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
11019
11020 Supported in default-server: No
11021
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011022slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011023 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
11024 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
11025 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
11026 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
11027 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
11028 parameters :
11029
11030 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
11031 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
11032
11033 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
11034 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
11035 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
11036 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
11037
11038 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
11039 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
11040 seen as failed.
11041
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011042 Supported in default-server: Yes
11043
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020011044sni <expression>
11045 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
11046 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
11047 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
11048 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
11049 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense.
11050
11051 Supported in default-server: no
11052
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011053source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011054source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011055source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011056 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
11057 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
11058 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
11059 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
11060
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011061 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
11062 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
11063 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
11064 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
11065 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
11066 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
11067 server.
11068
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000011069 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
11070 specifying the source address without port(s).
11071
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011072 Supported in default-server: No
11073
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011074ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020011075 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
11076 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
11077 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
11078 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
11079 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
11080 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011081 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011082
11083 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011084
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020011085tcp-ut <delay>
11086 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
11087 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
11088 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
11089 acknoledgement for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
11090 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
11091 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
11092 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
11093 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
11094 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
11095 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
11096 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
11097 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
11098 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11099
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011100track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020011101 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
11102 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
11103 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
11104 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011105 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
11106
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011107 Supported in default-server: No
11108
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011109verify [none|required]
11110 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010011111 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
11112 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
11113 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
11114 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020011115 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
11116 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
11117 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011118
11119 Supported in default-server: No
11120
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070011121verifyhost <hostname>
11122 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
11123 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
11124 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
11125 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
11126 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
11127 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
11128
11129 Supported in default-server: No
11130
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011131weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011132 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
11133 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
11134 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020011135 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
11136 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
11137 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
11138 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
11139 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
11140 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011141
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011142 Supported in default-server: Yes
11143
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011144
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200111455.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
11146-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011147
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011148HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
11149using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
11150configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011151This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
11152can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
11153workload.
11154This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
11155resolution at run time.
11156Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
11157carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
11158
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011159Bear in mind that DNS resolution is triggered by health checks. This makes
11160health checks mandatory to allow DNS resolution.
11161
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011162
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200111635.3.1. Global overview
11164----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011165
11166As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
11167different steps of the process life:
11168
11169 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
11170 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
11171 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
11172
11173 2. at run time, when HAProxy gets prepared to run a health check on a server,
11174 it verifies if the current name resolution is still considered as valid.
11175 If not, it processes a new resolution, in parallel of the health check.
11176
11177A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
11178 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
11179 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
11180 resolution to know this new IP.
11181
11182A few things important to notice:
11183 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
11184 first valid response.
11185
11186 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
11187 servers return an error.
11188
11189
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200111905.3.2. The resolvers section
11191----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011192
11193This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
11194HAProxy.
11195There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can contain
11196many name servers.
11197
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011198When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
11199uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
11200is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
11201answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
11202
11203When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
11204used by HAProxy to decide what type of behavior to apply.
11205
11206Two types of behavior can be applied:
11207 1. stop DNS resolution
11208 2. replay the DNS query with a new query type
11209 In such case, the following types are applied in this exact order:
11210 1. ANY query type
11211 2. query type corresponding to family pointed by resolve-prefer
11212 server's parameter
11213 3. remaining family type
11214
11215HAProxy stops DNS resolution when the following errors occur:
11216 - invalid DNS response packet
11217 - wrong name in the query section of the response
11218 - NX domain
11219 - Query refused by server
11220 - CNAME not pointing to an IP address
11221
11222HAProxy tries a new query type when the following errors occur:
11223 - no Answer records in the response
11224 - DNS response truncated
11225 - Error in DNS response
11226 - No expected DNS records found in the response
11227 - name server timeout
11228
11229For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section:
11230 - first response is valid and is applied directly, second response is ignored
11231 - first response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
11232 applied;
11233 - first response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
11234 HAProxy replays the query with a new type;
11235 - first response is truncated and second one is a NX Domain, then HAProxy
11236 stops resolution.
11237
11238
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011239resolvers <resolvers id>
11240 Creates a new name server list labelled <resolvers id>
11241
11242A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
11243
11244nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
11245 DNS server description:
11246 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
11247 <ip> : IP address of the server
11248 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
11249
11250hold <status> <period>
11251 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
11252 on last resolution <status>
11253 <status> : last name resolution status. Only "valid" is accepted for now.
11254 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
11255 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11256 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
11257
11258 Default value is 10s for "valid".
11259
11260 Note: since the name resolution is triggered by the health checks, a new
11261 resolution is triggered after <period> modulo the <inter> parameter of
11262 the healch check.
11263
11264resolve_retries <nb>
11265 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
11266 giving up.
11267 Default value: 3
11268
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011269 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
11270 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
11271 type.
11272
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011273timeout <event> <time>
11274 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
11275 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
11276 events available are:
11277 - retry: time between two DNS queries, when no response have
11278 been received.
11279 Default value: 1s
11280 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11281 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
11282
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011283 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011284
11285 resolvers mydns
11286 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
11287 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
11288 resolve_retries 3
11289 timeout retry 1s
11290 hold valid 10s
11291
11292
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200112936. HTTP header manipulation
11294---------------------------
11295
11296In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
11297response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
11298request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
11299which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011300against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011301
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011302If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
11303to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
11304but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
11305HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
11306stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
11307because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
11308a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
11309still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020011310
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011311This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
11312in section 4.2 :
11313
11314 - reqadd <string>
11315 - reqallow <search>
11316 - reqiallow <search>
11317 - reqdel <search>
11318 - reqidel <search>
11319 - reqdeny <search>
11320 - reqideny <search>
11321 - reqpass <search>
11322 - reqipass <search>
11323 - reqrep <search> <replace>
11324 - reqirep <search> <replace>
11325 - reqtarpit <search>
11326 - reqitarpit <search>
11327 - rspadd <string>
11328 - rspdel <search>
11329 - rspidel <search>
11330 - rspdeny <search>
11331 - rspideny <search>
11332 - rsprep <search> <replace>
11333 - rspirep <search> <replace>
11334
11335With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
11336is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
11337parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
11338prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
11339Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
11340
11341 \t for a tab
11342 \r for a carriage return (CR)
11343 \n for a new line (LF)
11344 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
11345 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
11346 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
11347 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
11348 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
11349
11350The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
11351portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
11352above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
11353regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
113549 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
11355is very common to users of the "sed" program.
11356
11357The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
11358after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
11359
11360Notes related to these keywords :
11361---------------------------------
11362 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
11363 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
11364 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
11365
11366 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
11367 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
11368 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
11369
11370 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
11371 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
11372 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
11373 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
11374 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
11375
11376 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
11377 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
11378 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
11379 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
11380 useless headers before adding new ones.
11381
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011382 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011383 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
11384
11385 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
11386 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
11387 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
11388
11389 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
11390 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011391 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011392
11393
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200113947. Using ACLs and fetching samples
11395----------------------------------
11396
11397Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
11398client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
11399The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
11400these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
11401but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
11402data called patterns.
11403
11404
114057.1. ACL basics
11406---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011407
11408The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
11409content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
11410from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
11411simple :
11412
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011413 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011414 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011415 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
11416 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011417
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011418The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
11419adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011420
11421In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
11422
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011423 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011424
11425This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
11426Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
11427and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011428an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
11429conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
11430as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
11431are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011432
11433ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
11434'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
11435which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
11436
11437There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
11438performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
11439
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011440The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
11441specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
11442this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011443methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
11444ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011445
11446Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
11447 - boolean
11448 - integer (signed or unsigned)
11449 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
11450 - string
11451 - data block
11452
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011453Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
11454converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
11455would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
11456The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
11457which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
11458
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011459Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
11460keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
11461fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
11462which are summarized in the table below :
11463
11464 +---------------------+-----------------+
11465 | Sample or converter | Default |
11466 | output type | matching method |
11467 +---------------------+-----------------+
11468 | boolean | bool |
11469 +---------------------+-----------------+
11470 | integer | int |
11471 +---------------------+-----------------+
11472 | ip | ip |
11473 +---------------------+-----------------+
11474 | string | str |
11475 +---------------------+-----------------+
11476 | binary | none, use "-m" |
11477 +---------------------+-----------------+
11478
11479Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
11480matching method, see below.
11481
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011482The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
11483 - boolean
11484 - integer or integer range
11485 - IP address / network
11486 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
11487 - regular expression
11488 - hex block
11489
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011490The following ACL flags are currently supported :
11491
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011492 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
11493 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011494 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010011495 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010011496 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010011497 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011498 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
11499
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011500The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
11501read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
11502if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
11503lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
11504will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
11505beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
11506a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
11507lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
11508exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
11509
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010011510The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
11511parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
11512ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
11513a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
11514check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
11515
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010011516The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
11517socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
11518file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
11519
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011520Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
11521loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
11522
11523 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
11524
11525In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
11526the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
11527case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
11528as well.
11529
11530The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
11531sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
11532do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
11533methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
11534is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
11535obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
11536followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
11537default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
11538that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
11539string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
11540
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010011541The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
11542By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
11543string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
11544resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
11545server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
11546waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
11547flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
11548function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
11549
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011550There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
11551sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
11552be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011553
11554 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
11555 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011556 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
11557 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
11558 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
11559 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011560
11561 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
11562 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011563 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011564
11565 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011566 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011567
11568 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011569 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011570
11571 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
11572 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
11573
11574 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
11575 binary or string samples.
11576
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011577 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
11578 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011579
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011580 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
11581 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
11582 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011583
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011584 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
11585 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011586
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011587 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
11588 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011589
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011590 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
11591 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011593 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
11594 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011595 This may be used with binary or string samples.
11596
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011597 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
11598 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
11599 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011600
11601For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
11602request, it is possible to do :
11603
11604 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
11605
11606In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
11607buffer, one would use the following acl :
11608
11609 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
11610
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011611On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
11612possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
11613
11614 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
11615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011616All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
11617criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
11618method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
11619to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
11620criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
11621the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011623If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011624the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
11625For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011626
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011627 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
11628 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
11629 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
11630 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011631
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011632
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011633The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
11634types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
11635combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
11636brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
11637default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011638
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011639 +-------------------------------------------------+
11640 | Input sample type |
11641 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011642 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011643 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
11644 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
11645 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011646 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011647 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011648 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011649 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011650 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011651 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011652 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011653 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011654 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011655 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011656 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011657 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011658 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011659 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011660 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011661 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011662 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011663 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011664 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011665 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011666 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011667 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
11668 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
11669 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011670
11671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200116727.1.1. Matching booleans
11673------------------------
11674
11675In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
11676Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
11677When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
11678that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
11679
11680Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
11681return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
11682"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
11683
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011684
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200116857.1.2. Matching integers
11686------------------------
11687
11688Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
11689enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
11690to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
11691
11692Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
11693matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
11694lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011695
11696For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
11697unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
11698representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
11699
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011700As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
11701two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
11702instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
11703ranges and operators.
11704
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011705For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011706operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
11707Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
11708of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011709
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011710Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011711
11712 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
11713 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
11714 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
11715 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
11716 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
11717
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011718For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011719
11720 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
11721
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011722This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
11723
11724 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
11725
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011726
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200117277.1.3. Matching strings
11728-----------------------
11729
11730String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
11731different forms :
11732
11733 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
11734 patterns ;
11735
11736 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
11737 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
11738
11739 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
11740 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
11741
11742 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
11743 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
11744
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010011745 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011746 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
11747 matches.
11748
11749 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
11750 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
11751 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011752
11753String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
11754exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
11755characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
11756string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
11757to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011758before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011759
11760
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200117617.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
11762---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011763
11764Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
11765they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
11766possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
11767passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
11768the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011769the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
11770match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011771
11772
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200117737.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
11774-------------------------------------
11775
11776It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
11777not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
11778a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
11779to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
11780digits may be used upper or lower case.
11781
11782Example :
11783 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
11784 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
11785
11786
117877.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
11788---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011789
11790IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
11791netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
11792within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011793host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011794difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
11795at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
11796does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
11797parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011798
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020011799The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
11800abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
11801
11802 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
11803 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
11804 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
11805 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
11806 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
11807 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
11808 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
11809 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
11810
11811Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
11812192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
11813
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011814IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
11815Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
11816trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
11817IPv6 patterns.
11818
11819HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
11820following situations :
11821 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
11822 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
11823 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
11824 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
11825 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
11826 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
11827 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
11828 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
11829 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
11830 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
11831
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011832
118337.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
11834----------------------------------
11835
11836Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
11837combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
11838
11839 - AND (implicit)
11840 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
11841 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011842
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011843A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011844
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011845 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020011846
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011847Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
11848indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020011849
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011850For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
11851"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
11852requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
11853is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
11854
11855 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
11856 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
11857 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
11858 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
11859
11860To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
11861and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
11862
11863 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
11864 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
11865 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
11866 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
11867
11868 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
11869 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
11870 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
11871 use_backend www if host_www
11872
11873It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
11874expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
11875be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
11876the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
11877
11878 The following rule :
11879
11880 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
11881 block if METH_POST missing_cl
11882
11883 Can also be written that way :
11884
11885 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
11886
11887It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
11888to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
11889simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
11890sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
11891good use is the following :
11892
11893 With named ACLs :
11894
11895 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
11896 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
11897 monitor fail if site_dead
11898
11899 With anonymous ACLs :
11900
11901 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
11902
11903See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
11904
11905
119067.3. Fetching samples
11907---------------------
11908
11909Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
11910against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
11911sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
11912ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
11913of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
11914available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
11915
11916This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
11917Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
11918compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
11919deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
11920
11921The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
11922matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
11923method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
11924indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
11925
11926As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
11927when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
11928mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
11929the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
11930ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
11931
11932Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
11933multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
11934when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
11935incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
11936are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
11937is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
11938all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
11939
11940Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
11941 - name
11942 - name(arg1)
11943 - name(arg1,arg2)
11944
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011945
119467.3.1. Converters
11947-----------------
11948
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011949Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
11950of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
11951is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
11952was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
11953has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
11954unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
11955
11956These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
11957sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
11958the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
11959support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011960
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011961A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
11962support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
11963supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
11964(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
11965bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
11966
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011967The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011968
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011969add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011970 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011971 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011972 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
11973 scopes allowed are:
11974 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11975 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
11976 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
11977 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
11978 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011979 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011980
11981and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011982 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011983 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011984 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
11985 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
11986 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11987 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
11988 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
11989 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
11990 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011991 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011992
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020011993base64
11994 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
11995 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
11996 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
11997
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011998bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011999 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012000 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
12001 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
12002 presence of a flag).
12003
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010012004bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
12005 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
12006 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
12007 optionnaly truncated at the given length.
12008
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012009cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012010 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
12011 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012012
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012013crc32([<avalanche>])
12014 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
12015 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12016 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12017 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12018 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12019 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
12020 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
12021 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
12022 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
12023 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
12024 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type" directive.
12025
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010012026da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012027 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
12028 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
12029 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
12030 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000012031 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012032 configuration language.
12033
12034 Example:
12035 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020012036 bind *:8881
12037 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000012038 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012039
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020012040debug
12041 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
12042 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
12043 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
12044
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012045div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012046 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12047 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012048 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012049 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12050 scope. The scopes allowed are:
12051 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12052 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12053 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12054 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12055 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012056 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012057
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012058djb2([<avalanche>])
12059 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
12060 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12061 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12062 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12063 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12064 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12065 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012066 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6" and the
12067 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012068
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012069even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012070 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012071 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
12072
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010012073field(<index>,<delimiters>)
12074 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
12075 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
12076 list of chars.
12077
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012078hex
12079 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
12080 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
12081 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
12082 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010012083
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012084http_date([<offset>])
12085 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12086 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
12087 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
12088 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
12089 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
12090 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012091
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012092in_table(<table>)
12093 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12094 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
12095 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
12096 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
12097 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
12098
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012099ipmask(<mask>)
12100 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
12101 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
12102 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
12103 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
12104
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012105json([<input-code>])
12106 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
12107 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020012108 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012109 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
12110 of errors:
12111 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
12112 bytes, ...)
12113 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
12114 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
12115
12116 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
12117 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
12118 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
12119 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
12120 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
12121 are :
12122 - "ascii" : never fails ;
12123 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
12124 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
12125 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
12126 error ;
12127 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
12128 characters corresponding to the other errors.
12129
12130 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
12131 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
12132
12133 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012134 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020012135 capture request header user-agent len 150
12136 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012137
12138 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
12139 GET / HTTP/1.0
12140 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
12141
12142 Output log:
12143 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
12144
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012145language(<value>[,<default>])
12146 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
12147 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
12148 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
12149 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
12150 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
12151 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
12152 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
12153 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
12154 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
12155 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
12156 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
12157 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012158
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012159 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012160
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012161 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
12162 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012163
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012164 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
12165 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
12166 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
12167 use_backend spanish if es
12168 use_backend french if fr
12169 use_backend english if en
12170 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012171
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012172lower
12173 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
12174 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
12175 type. The result is of type string.
12176
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020012177ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
12178 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12179 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
12180 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
12181 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
12182 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
12183 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
12184
12185 Example :
12186
12187 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
12188 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
12189 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
12190
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012191map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12192map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12193map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12194 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
12195 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
12196 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
12197 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
12198 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
12199 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
12200 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
12201 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012202
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012203 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
12204 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
12205 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012206
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012207 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
12208 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012209
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012210 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
12211 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12212 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
12213 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020012214 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
12215 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012216 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
12217 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12218 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
12219 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12220 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
12221 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12222 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
12223 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010012224 | | map_reg | |
12225 str | reg +-----------------+ map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
12226 | | map_regm | |
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012227 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12228 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
12229 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12230 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
12231 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012232
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010012233 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
12234 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
12235 the corresponding match text.
12236
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012237 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
12238 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
12239 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
12240 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
12241 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012242
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012243 Example :
12244
12245 # this is a comment and is ignored
12246 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
12247 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
12248 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
12249 | | | `---------- value
12250 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
12251 | `---------------------------- key
12252 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
12253
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012254mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012255 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12256 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012257 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012258 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12259 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12260 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12261 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12262 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12263 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012264 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012265
12266mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012267 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020012268 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
12269 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012270 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012271 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12272 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12273 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12274 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12275 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12276 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012277 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012278
12279neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012280 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
12281 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
12282 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
12283 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012284
12285not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012286 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012287 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
12288 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
12289 absence of a flag).
12290
12291odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012292 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012293 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
12294
12295or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012296 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012297 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012298 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12299 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12300 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12301 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12302 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12303 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12304 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012305 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012306
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010012307regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012308 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
12309 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
12310 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
12311 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
12312 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
12313 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
12314 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
12315 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
12316 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
12317 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010012318 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
12319 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
12320 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
12321 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012322
12323 Example :
12324
12325 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
12326 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
12327 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
12328 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
12329
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012330capture-req(<id>)
12331 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
12332 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12333
12334 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020012335 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
12336 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012337
12338capture-res(<id>)
12339 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
12340 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12341
12342 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020012343 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
12344 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012345
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012346sdbm([<avalanche>])
12347 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
12348 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12349 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12350 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12351 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12352 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12353 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012354 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6" and the
12355 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012356
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012357set-var(<var name>)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012358 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output as
12359 is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of the
12360 variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12361 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12362 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012363 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012364 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12365 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012366 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12367 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
12368
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012369sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012370 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
12371 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012372 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012373 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12374 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12375 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12376 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012377 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012378 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12379 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012380 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12381 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012382
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012383table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
12384 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12385 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12386 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
12387 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
12388 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
12389 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
12390
12391
12392table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
12393 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12394 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12395 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
12396 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
12397 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
12398 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
12399
12400table_conn_cnt(<table>)
12401 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12402 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12403 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
12404 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
12405 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12406
12407table_conn_cur(<table>)
12408 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12409 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12410 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
12411 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
12412 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
12413
12414table_conn_rate(<table>)
12415 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12416 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12417 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
12418 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
12419 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
12420
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012421table_gpt0(<table>)
12422 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12423 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
12424 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
12425 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
12426 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
12427
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012428table_gpc0(<table>)
12429 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12430 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12431 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
12432 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
12433 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
12434
12435table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
12436 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12437 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12438 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
12439 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
12440 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
12441 sample fetch keyword.
12442
12443table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
12444 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12445 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12446 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
12447 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
12448 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12449
12450table_http_err_rate(<table>)
12451 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12452 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12453 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
12454 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
12455 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
12456 keyword.
12457
12458table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
12459 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12460 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12461 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
12462 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
12463 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12464
12465table_http_req_rate(<table>)
12466 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12467 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12468 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
12469 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
12470 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
12471 keyword.
12472
12473table_kbytes_in(<table>)
12474 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12475 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12476 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
12477 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
12478 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
12479 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
12480 keyword.
12481
12482table_kbytes_out(<table>)
12483 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12484 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12485 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
12486 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
12487 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
12488 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
12489 keyword.
12490
12491table_server_id(<table>)
12492 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12493 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12494 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
12495 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
12496 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
12497 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
12498
12499table_sess_cnt(<table>)
12500 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12501 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12502 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
12503 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
12504 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
12505 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
12506 keyword.
12507
12508table_sess_rate(<table>)
12509 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12510 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12511 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
12512 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
12513 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
12514 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
12515 keyword.
12516
12517table_trackers(<table>)
12518 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12519 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12520 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
12521 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
12522 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
12523 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
12524 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
12525 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
12526 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
12527 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
12528
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012529upper
12530 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
12531 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
12532 type. The result is of type string.
12533
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020012534url_dec
12535 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
12536 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
12537
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020012538utime(<format>[,<offset>])
12539 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12540 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
12541 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
12542 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
12543 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
12544 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
12545
12546 Example :
12547
12548 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
12549 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
12550 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
12551
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010012552word(<index>,<delimiters>)
12553 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
12554 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
12555
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012556wt6([<avalanche>])
12557 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
12558 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12559 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12560 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12561 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12562 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12563 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012564 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", and the
12565 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012566
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012567xor(<value>)
12568 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012569 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012570 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012571 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12572 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12573 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012574 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012575 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12576 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012577 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12578 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012579
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012580
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200125817.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012582--------------------------------------------
12583
12584A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
12585not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
12586"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
12587The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
12588
12589always_false : boolean
12590 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
12591 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
12592
12593always_true : boolean
12594 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
12595 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
12596
12597avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012598 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012599 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
12600 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
12601 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
12602 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
12603 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
12604 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
12605 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
12606 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
12607 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
12608 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
12609 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
12610 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
12611 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010012612
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012613be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012614 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
12615 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
12616 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
12617 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
12618 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012619
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012620be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
12621 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
12622 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
12623 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
12624 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
12625 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
12626 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012627
12628 Example :
12629 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
12630 backend dynamic
12631 mode http
12632 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
12633 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012634
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020012635bin(<hexa>) : bin
12636 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
12637 of the string.
12638
12639bool(<bool>) : bool
12640 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
12641 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
12642
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012643connslots([<backend>]) : integer
12644 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012645 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012646 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
12647 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050012648
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012649 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012650 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012651 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
12652
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012653 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
12654 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012655
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012656 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012657 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012658 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012659 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
12660 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012661 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012662 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012663
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012664 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
12665 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012666 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012667 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012668
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020012669date([<offset>]) : integer
12670 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
12671 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
12672 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
12673 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020012674 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
12675
12676 Example :
12677
12678 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
12679 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020012680
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020012681env(<name>) : string
12682 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
12683 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
12684 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
12685 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
12686 certain way.
12687
12688 Examples :
12689 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
12690 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
12691
12692 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
12693 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
12694
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012695fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
12696 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012697 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
12698 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012699 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
12700 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
12701 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
12702 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
12703 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012704
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020012705fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
12706 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
12707 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
12708 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
12709
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012710fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
12711 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
12712 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
12713 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
12714 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
12715 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
12716 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
12717 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
12718 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010012719
12720 Example :
12721 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
12722 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
12723 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
12724 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
12725 frontend mail
12726 bind :25
12727 mode tcp
12728 maxconn 100
12729 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
12730 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
12731 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
12732 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012733
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012734int(<integer>) : signed integer
12735 Returns a signed integer.
12736
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020012737ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
12738 Returns an ipv4.
12739
12740ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
12741 Returns an ipv6.
12742
12743meth(<method>) : method
12744 Returns a method.
12745
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010012746nbproc : integer
12747 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
12748 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
12749 and debugging purposes.
12750
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012751nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
12752 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
12753 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
12754 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012755 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
12756 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
12757 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010012758
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010012759proc : integer
12760 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
12761 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
12762 debugging purposes.
12763
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012764queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012765 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
12766 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
12767 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012768 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
12769 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
12770 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
12771 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
12772 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
12773
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010012774rand([<range>]) : integer
12775 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
12776 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
12777 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
12778 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
12779 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
12780
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012781srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
12782 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
12783 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
12784 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
12785 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
12786 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
12787 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
12788 methods.
12789
12790srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
12791 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
12792 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
12793 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
12794 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
12795 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
12796 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
12797 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
12798
12799srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
12800 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
12801 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012802 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012803 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
12804 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
12805 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
12806 overloading servers).
12807
12808 Example :
12809 # Redirect to a separate back
12810 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
12811 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
12812 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
12813
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010012814stopping : boolean
12815 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
12816 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
12817 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
12818
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020012819str(<string>) : string
12820 Returns a string.
12821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012822table_avl([<table>]) : integer
12823 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
12824 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
12825
12826table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12827 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
12828 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
12829 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
12830
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012831var(<var-name>) : undefined
12832 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012833 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
12834 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12835 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12836 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012837 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012838 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12839 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012840 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12841 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
12842
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200128437.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012844----------------------------------
12845
12846The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
12847closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
12848methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
12849sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
12850TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012851the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
12852counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
12853"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012854argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
12855the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
12856this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012857
12858be_id : integer
12859 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
12860 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
12861
12862dst : ip
12863 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
12864 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
12865 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
12866 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
12867 RFC 4291.
12868
12869dst_conn : integer
12870 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
12871 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
12872 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
12873 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
12874 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
12875 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
12876 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
12877 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012878
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020012879dst_is_local : boolean
12880 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
12881 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
12882 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
12883 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
12884 targetting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
12885 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
12886 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
12887 it only once per connection.
12888
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012889dst_port : integer
12890 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
12891 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
12892 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
12893 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
12894 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
12895 an HTTP header.
12896
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020012897fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
12898 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
12899 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
12900 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
12901 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
12902 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
12903 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
12904
12905fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
12906 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
12907 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
12908 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
12909 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
12910 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
12911 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
12912
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070012913fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
12914 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
12915 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
12916 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
12917 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
12918
12919fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
12920 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
12921 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
12922 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
12923 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
12924
12925fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
12926 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
12927 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
12928 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
12929 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
12930
12931fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
12932 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
12933 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
12934 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
12935 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
12936
12937fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
12938 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
12939 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
12940 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
12941 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
12942
12943fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
12944 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
12945 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
12946 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
12947 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
12948
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012949fe_id : integer
12950 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
12951 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
12952 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
12953
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012954sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012955sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
12956sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
12957sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012958 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
12959 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
12960 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
12961
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012962sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012963sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
12964sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
12965sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012966 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
12967 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
12968 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
12969
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012970sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012971sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12972sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12973sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012974 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
12975 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010012976 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
12977 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
12978 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012979
12980 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
12981 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012982 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
12983 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
12984 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012985 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
12986 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
12987
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012988sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012989sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12990sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12991sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012992 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
12993 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
12994
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012995sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012996sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
12997sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
12998sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012999 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
13000 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
13001 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
13002
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013003sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013004sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13005sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13006sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013007 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
13008 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
13009 See also src_conn_rate.
13010
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013011sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013012sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13013sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13014sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013015 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013016 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013017
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013018sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
13019sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13020sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13021sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13022 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
13023 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
13024
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013025sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013026sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
13027sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
13028sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013029 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
13030 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
13031 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013032 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
13033 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
13034 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013035
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013036sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013037sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13038sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13039sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013040 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
13041 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
13042 See also src_http_err_cnt.
13043
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013044sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013045sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13046sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13047sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013048 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
13049 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
13050 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
13051 src_http_err_rate.
13052
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013053sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013054sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13055sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13056sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013057 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
13058 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
13059 src_http_req_cnt.
13060
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013061sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013062sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13063sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13064sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013065 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
13066 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
13067 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
13068 src_http_req_rate.
13069
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013070sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013071sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13072sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13073sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013074 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013075 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
13076 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
13077 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
13078 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013079
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013080 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
13081 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013082 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13083
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013084sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013085sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
13086sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
13087sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013088 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
13089 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
13090 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013091
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013092sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013093sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
13094sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
13095sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013096 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
13097 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
13098 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013099
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013100sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013101sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13102sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13103sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013104 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
13105 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
13106 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
13107 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013108 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013109 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
13110
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013111sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013112sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13113sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13114sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013115 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
13116 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
13117 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
13118 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
13119 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013120 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013121
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013122sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013123sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
13124sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
13125sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020013126 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
13127 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
13128 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
13129
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013130sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013131sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
13132sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
13133sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013134 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
13135 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013136 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013137 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
13138 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013139 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
13140 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
13141 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013142
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013143so_id : integer
13144 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
13145 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
13146 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013148src : ip
13149 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
13150 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
13151 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
13152 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013153 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
13154 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
13155 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
13156 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013157
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013158 Example:
13159 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
13160 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
13161
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013162src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13163 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
13164 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
13165 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013166 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013167
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013168src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13169 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
13170 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013171 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013172 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013173
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013174src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13175 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
13176 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13177 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
13178 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
13179 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
13180 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013181
13182 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
13183 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
13184 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
13185 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013186 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013187 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
13188 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13189
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013190src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013191 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013192 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013193 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013194 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013195
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013196src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013197 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013198 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
13199 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013200 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013201
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013202src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13203 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
13204 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13205 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013206 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013207
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013208src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013209 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013210 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013211 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013212 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013213
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013214src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13215 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
13216 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
13217 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
13218 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
13219
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013220src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013221 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013222 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013223 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
13224 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013225 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
13226 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
13227 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013228
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013229src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13230 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
13231 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013232 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013233 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013234 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013235
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013236src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13237 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
13238 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13239 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
13240 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013241 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013242
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013243src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13244 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
13245 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
13246 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013247 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013248
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013249src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13250 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
13251 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
13252 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013253 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013254 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013255
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013256src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13257 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
13258 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13259 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013260 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013261 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
13262 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013263
13264 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013265 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013266 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013267
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020013268src_is_local : boolean
13269 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
13270 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
13271 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
13272 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
13273 client comes from (eg: require auth or https for remote machines). Please
13274 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
13275 once per connection.
13276
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013277src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013278 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
13279 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
13280 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
13281 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
13282 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013283
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013284src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013285 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
13286 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13287 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
13288 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
13289 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013290
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013291src_port : integer
13292 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
13293 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
13294 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
13295 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013296
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013297src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13298 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013299 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13300 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
13301 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013302 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013303
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013304src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13305 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
13306 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13307 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
13308 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013309 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013310
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013311src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13312 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
13313 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
13314 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
13315 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
13316 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
13317 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
13318 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
13319 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013320
13321 Example :
13322 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
13323 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
13324 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
13325 listen ssh
13326 bind :22
13327 mode tcp
13328 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013329 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013330 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013331 server local 127.0.0.1:22
13332
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013333srv_id : integer
13334 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
13335 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
13336 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020013337
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200133387.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013339----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020013340
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013341The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
13342closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
13343when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
13344usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013345future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020013346
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013347ssl_bc : boolean
13348 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
13349 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
13350 other a server with the "ssl" option.
13351
13352ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
13353 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
13354 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13355
13356ssl_bc_cipher : string
13357 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
13358 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13359
13360ssl_bc_protocol : string
13361 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
13362 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13363
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013364ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013365 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013366 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
13367 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013368
13369ssl_bc_session_id : binary
13370 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
13371 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
13372 if session was reused or not.
13373
13374ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
13375 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
13376 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13377
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013378ssl_c_ca_err : integer
13379 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13380 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
13381 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
13382 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
13383 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020013384
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013385ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
13386 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13387 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
13388 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
13389 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013390
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010013391ssl_c_der : binary
13392 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
13393 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13394 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
13395
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013396ssl_c_err : integer
13397 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13398 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
13399 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
13400 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
13401 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013402
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013403ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13404 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13405 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
13406 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13407 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13408 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13409 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13410 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13411 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013412
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013413ssl_c_key_alg : string
13414 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
13415 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13416 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013417
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013418ssl_c_notafter : string
13419 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
13420 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13421 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020013422
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013423ssl_c_notbefore : string
13424 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
13425 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13426 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010013427
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013428ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13429 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13430 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
13431 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13432 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13433 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13434 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13435 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13436 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010013437
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013438ssl_c_serial : binary
13439 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
13440 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13441 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013442
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013443ssl_c_sha1 : binary
13444 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
13445 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
13446 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020013447 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
13448 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
13449
13450 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013451
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013452ssl_c_sig_alg : string
13453 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
13454 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
13455 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013456
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013457ssl_c_used : boolean
13458 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
13459 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013460
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013461ssl_c_verify : integer
13462 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
13463 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
13464 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
13465 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013466
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013467ssl_c_version : integer
13468 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
13469 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013470
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010013471ssl_f_der : binary
13472 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
13473 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13474 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
13475
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013476ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13477 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13478 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
13479 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13480 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013481 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013482 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13483 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13484 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013485
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013486ssl_f_key_alg : string
13487 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
13488 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
13489 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013490
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013491ssl_f_notafter : string
13492 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
13493 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13494 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013495
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013496ssl_f_notbefore : string
13497 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
13498 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13499 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013500
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013501ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13502 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13503 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
13504 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13505 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13506 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13507 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13508 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13509 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013510
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013511ssl_f_serial : binary
13512 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
13513 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13514 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013515
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020013516ssl_f_sha1 : binary
13517 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
13518 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
13519 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
13520
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013521ssl_f_sig_alg : string
13522 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
13523 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
13524 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013526ssl_f_version : integer
13527 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
13528 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13529
13530ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013531 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
13532 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
13533 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
13534
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013535 Example :
13536 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
13537 listen http-https
13538 bind :80
13539 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
13540 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
13541
13542ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
13543 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
13544 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13545
13546ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013547 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013548 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
13549 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
13550 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
13551 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
13552 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
13553 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
13554 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
13555 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
13556
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013557ssl_fc_cipher : string
13558 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
13559 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013560
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013561ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013562 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
13563 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010013564 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
13565 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
13566 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
13567 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013568
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013569ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
13570 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020013571 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
13572 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
13573 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
13574 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020013575
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020013576ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020013577 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
13578 SSL session cache or TLS tickets.
13579
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013580ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013581 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013582 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
13583 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
13584 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
13585 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
13586 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
13587 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
13588 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020013589
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013590ssl_fc_protocol : string
13591 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
13592 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020013593
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013594ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040013595 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013596 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
13597 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040013598
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013599ssl_fc_session_id : binary
13600 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
13601 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
13602 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
13603 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020013604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013605ssl_fc_sni : string
13606 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
13607 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
13608 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
13609 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
13610 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
13611
13612 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
13613 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
13614 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020013615 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
13616 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013617
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013618 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013619 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
13620 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020013621
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013622ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
13623 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
13624 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020013625
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020013626
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200136277.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013628------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020013629
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013630Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
13631sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
13632only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
13633For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
13634be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
13635can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
13636sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
13637for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
13638content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013639
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013640payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
13641 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
13642 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
13643 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013644
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013645payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
13646 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
13647 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
13648 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013649
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013650req.len : integer
13651req_len : integer (deprecated)
13652 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
13653 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
13654 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
13655 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
13656 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
13657 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
13658 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
13659 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013660
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013661req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
13662 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020013663 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
13664 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
13665 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
13666 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013667
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013668 ACL alternatives :
13669 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013670
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013671req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
13672 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
13673 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
13674 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
13675 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013676
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013677 ACL alternatives :
13678 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013679
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013680 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013681
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013682req.proto_http : boolean
13683req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
13684 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
13685 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
13686 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
13687 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
13688 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
13689 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
13690 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013691
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013692 Example:
13693 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
13694 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
13695 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013696 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013697
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013698req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
13699rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13700 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
13701 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
13702 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
13703 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
13704 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
13705 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
13706 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013707
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013708 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
13709 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
13710 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
13711 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
13712 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
13713 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013714
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013715 ACL derivatives :
13716 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013717
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013718 Example :
13719 listen tse-farm
13720 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
13721 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
13722 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
13723 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
13724 # apply RDP cookie persistence
13725 persist rdp-cookie
13726 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
13727 # This is only useful makes sense if
13728 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
13729 stick-table type string size 204800
13730 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
13731 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
13732 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013733
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013734 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
13735 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013736
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013737req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
13738rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
13739 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
13740 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
13741 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
13742 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013743
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013744 ACL derivatives :
13745 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013746
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020013747req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
13748 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
13749 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013750 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
13751 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
13752 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
13753 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
13754 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020013755
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013756req.ssl_hello_type : integer
13757req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
13758 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
13759 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
13760 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
13761 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
13762 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
13763 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
13764 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013765
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013766req.ssl_sni : string
13767req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
13768 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
13769 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
13770 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
13771 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
13772 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
13773 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
13774 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
13775 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
13776 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
13777 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
13778 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
13779 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013780
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013781 ACL derivatives :
13782 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013783
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013784 Examples :
13785 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
13786 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
13787 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
13788 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
13789 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013790
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053013791req.ssl_st_ext : integer
13792 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
13793 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
13794 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
13795 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
13796 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
13797 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
13798 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
13799 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
13800 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
13801
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013802req.ssl_ver : integer
13803req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
13804 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
13805 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
13806 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
13807 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
13808 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
13809 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
13810 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
13811 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
13812 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013813
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013814 ACL derivatives :
13815 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013816
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020013817res.len : integer
13818 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
13819 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
13820 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
13821 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
13822 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
13823 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
13824 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
13825 content inspection.
13826
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013827res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
13828 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020013829 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
13830 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
13831 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
13832 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013833
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013834res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
13835 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
13836 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
13837 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
13838 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013839
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013840 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013841
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020013842res.ssl_hello_type : integer
13843rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
13844 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
13845 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
13846 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
13847 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
13848 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
13849 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
13850 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
13851
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013852wait_end : boolean
13853 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
13854 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
13855 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
13856 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
13857 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
13858 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
13859 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
13860 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013861
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013862 Examples :
13863 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
13864 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
13865 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013866
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013867 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
13868 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
13869 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
13870 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
13871 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
13872 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
13873 tcp-request content reject
13874
13875
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200138767.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013877--------------------------------------
13878
13879It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
13880This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
13881data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
13882its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
13883HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
13884content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
13885to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
13886more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
13887response are indexed.
13888
13889base : string
13890 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
13891 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
13892 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
13893 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
13894 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
13895 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
13896 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
13897 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
13898
13899 ACL derivatives :
13900 base : exact string match
13901 base_beg : prefix match
13902 base_dir : subdir match
13903 base_dom : domain match
13904 base_end : suffix match
13905 base_len : length match
13906 base_reg : regex match
13907 base_sub : substring match
13908
13909base32 : integer
13910 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
13911 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
13912 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013913 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
13914 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
13915 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013916
13917base32+src : binary
13918 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
13919 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
13920 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
13921 per-URL counters.
13922
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010013923capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
13924 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
13925 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
13926 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
13927
13928capture.req.method : string
13929 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
13930 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
13931 because it's allocated.
13932
13933capture.req.uri : string
13934 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
13935 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
13936 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
13937 allocated.
13938
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020013939capture.req.ver : string
13940 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
13941 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
13942 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
13943
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010013944capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
13945 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
13946 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
13947 The first entry is an index of 0.
13948 See also: "capture response header"
13949
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020013950capture.res.ver : string
13951 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
13952 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
13953 persistent flag.
13954
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020013955req.body : binary
13956 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
13957 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
13958 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
13959 the first chunk is analyzed.
13960
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020013961req.body_param([<name>) : string
13962 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
13963 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
13964 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
13965 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
13966 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
13967 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
13968 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
13969 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
13970 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
13971 given.
13972
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020013973req.body_len : integer
13974 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
13975 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
13976 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
13977 "option http-buffer-request".
13978
13979req.body_size : integer
13980 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
13981 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
13982 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
13983 that the request body has been buffered made available using
13984 "option http-buffer-request".
13985
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013986req.cook([<name>]) : string
13987cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13988 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
13989 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
13990 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
13991 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
13992 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
13993 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
13994 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
13995 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
13996
13997 ACL derivatives :
13998 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
13999 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
14000 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
14001 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
14002 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
14003 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
14004 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
14005 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014006
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014007req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14008cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14009 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
14010 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014011
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014012req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
14013cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14014 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14015 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
14016 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
14017 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014018
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014019cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14020 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14021 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
14022 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
14023 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020014024 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014025 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
14026 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
14027 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
14028 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014029
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014030hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14031 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
14032 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
14033 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
14034 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014035 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014036
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014037req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
14038 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
14039 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
14040 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14041 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14042 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14043 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
14044 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
14045 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014046
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014047req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14048 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
14049 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14050 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
14051 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014052
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014053req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14054 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
14055 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
14056 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14057 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14058 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14059 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
14060 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
14061 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
14062 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
14063 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
14064 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014065
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014066 ACL derivatives :
14067 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
14068 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
14069 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
14070 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
14071 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
14072 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
14073 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
14074 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
14075
14076req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14077hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
14078 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
14079 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
14080 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
14081 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
14082 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
14083 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
14084 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
14085 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
14086 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
14087
14088req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
14089hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
14090 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
14091 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
14092 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
14093 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
14094 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
14095 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
14096 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
14097 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
14098
14099req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
14100hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
14101 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
14102 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
14103 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
14104 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14105 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14106 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14107 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
14108
14109http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
14110 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
14111 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
14112 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
14113 basic auth is supported.
14114
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010014115http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
14116 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
14117 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
14118 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
14119 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014120 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
14121 basic auth is supported.
14122
14123 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010014124 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
14125 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
14126 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
14127 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014128
14129http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020014130 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
14131 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014132 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
14133 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020014134
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014135method : integer + string
14136 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
14137 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
14138 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
14139 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
14140 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
14141 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
14142 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014143
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014144 ACL derivatives :
14145 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014146
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014147 Example :
14148 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
14149 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
14150 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014151
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014152path : string
14153 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
14154 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
14155 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
14156 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
14157 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
14158 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
14159 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014160
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014161 ACL derivatives :
14162 path : exact string match
14163 path_beg : prefix match
14164 path_dir : subdir match
14165 path_dom : domain match
14166 path_end : suffix match
14167 path_len : length match
14168 path_reg : regex match
14169 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014170
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010014171query : string
14172 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
14173 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
14174 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
14175 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
14176 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the completemnt of "path"
14177 which stops before the question mark.
14178
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010014179req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
14180 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
14181 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
14182 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
14183 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
14184
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014185req.ver : string
14186req_ver : string (deprecated)
14187 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
14188 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
14189 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014190
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014191 ACL derivatives :
14192 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014193
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014194res.comp : boolean
14195 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
14196 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
14197 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014198
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014199res.comp_algo : string
14200 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
14201 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
14202 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014203
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014204res.cook([<name>]) : string
14205scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14206 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14207 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
14208 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020014209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014210 ACL derivatives :
14211 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020014212
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014213res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14214scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14215 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
14216 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
14217 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014218
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014219res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
14220scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14221 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14222 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
14223 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014224
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014225res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14226 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
14227 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
14228 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
14229 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
14230 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
14231 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
14232 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
14233 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
14234 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014235
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014236res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14237 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
14238 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14239 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
14240 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
14241 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014242
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014243res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14244shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
14245 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
14246 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
14247 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
14248 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
14249 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
14250 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
14251 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
14252 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014253
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014254 ACL derivatives :
14255 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
14256 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
14257 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
14258 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
14259 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
14260 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
14261 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
14262 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
14263
14264res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14265shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14266 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
14267 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14268 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
14269 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
14270 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014271
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014272res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
14273shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
14274 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
14275 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
14276 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
14277 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
14278 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
14279 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014280
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010014281res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
14282 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
14283 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
14284 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
14285 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
14286
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014287res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
14288shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
14289 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
14290 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
14291 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
14292 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
14293 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
14294 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010014295
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014296res.ver : string
14297resp_ver : string (deprecated)
14298 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
14299 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014300
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014301 ACL derivatives :
14302 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010014303
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014304set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14305 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14306 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020014307 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014308 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010014309
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014310 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
14311 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010014312
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014313status : integer
14314 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
14315 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
14316 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014317
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020014318unique-id : string
14319 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
14320 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
14321 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
14322 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
14323 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
14324 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
14325
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014326url : string
14327 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
14328 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
14329 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
14330 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
14331 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
14332 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
14333 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014334
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014335 ACL derivatives :
14336 url : exact string match
14337 url_beg : prefix match
14338 url_dir : subdir match
14339 url_dom : domain match
14340 url_end : suffix match
14341 url_len : length match
14342 url_reg : regex match
14343 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014344
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014345url_ip : ip
14346 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
14347 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
14348 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
14349 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
14350 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
14351 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
14352 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014353
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014354url_port : integer
14355 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
14356 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
14357 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
14358 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014359
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014360urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
14361url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014362 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
14363 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014364 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
14365 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
14366 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
14367 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014368 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
14369 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014370 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
14371 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014372
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014373 ACL derivatives :
14374 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
14375 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
14376 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
14377 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
14378 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
14379 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
14380 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
14381 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014382
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014383
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014384 Example :
14385 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
14386 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
14387 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
14388 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014389
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014390urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>])] : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014391 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
14392 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
14393 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020014394
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020014395url32 : integer
14396 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
14397 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
14398 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
14399 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
14400 is an unsigned integer.
14401
14402url32+src : binary
14403 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
14404 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
14405 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
14406
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010014407
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200144087.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014409---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014410
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014411Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
14412every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020014413order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014414
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014415ACL name Equivalent to Usage
14416---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014417FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020014418HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014419HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
14420HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014421HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
14422HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
14423HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
14424HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
14425LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014426METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020014427METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014428METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
14429METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
14430METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
14431METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020014432METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014433METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020014434RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014435REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014436TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014437WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
14438---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014439
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010014440
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200144418. Logging
14442----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014443
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014444One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
14445provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
14446very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
14447provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
14448state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014449to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014450headers.
14451
14452In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
14453about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
14454send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
14455
14456 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
14457 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
14458 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
14459 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
14460 at the termination.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060014461 - per-request control of log-level, eg:
14462 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014463
14464The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
14465allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
14466as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
14467while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
14468real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
14469delay.
14470
14471
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200144728.1. Log levels
14473---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014474
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014475TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014476source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014477HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
14478in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
14479track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
14480syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
14481about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014482
14483
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200144848.2. Log formats
14485----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014486
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014487HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014488and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
14489slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
14490options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014491
14492 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
14493 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
14494 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
14495 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
14496 extents.
14497
14498 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
14499 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
14500 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
14501 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
14502 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
14503
14504 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
14505 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
14506 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
14507 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
14508 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
14509
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020014510 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
14511 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
14512 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
14513 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
14514
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014515 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
14516
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014517Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
14518specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
14519field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
14520servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
14521always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
14522identifier.
14523
14524Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
14525 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
14526 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
14527 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
14528 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
14529
14530
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145318.2.1. Default log format
14532-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014533
14534This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
14535as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
14536format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
14537
14538 Example :
14539 listen www
14540 mode http
14541 log global
14542 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
14543
14544 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
14545 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
14546 (www/HTTP)
14547
14548 Field Format Extract from the example above
14549 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
14550 2 'Connect from' Connect from
14551 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
14552 4 'to' to
14553 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
14554 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
14555
14556Detailed fields description :
14557 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
14558 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
14559 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
14560 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
14561 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
14562 and processed the connection.
14563 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
14564
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014565In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
14566"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
14567connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
14568
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014569It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
14570will eventually disappear.
14571
14572
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145738.2.2. TCP log format
14574---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014575
14576The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
14577is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
14578information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
14579counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
14580emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
14581environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
14582the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
14583sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014584specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
14585not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
14586fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
14587marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014588
14589 Example :
14590 frontend fnt
14591 mode tcp
14592 option tcplog
14593 log global
14594 default_backend bck
14595
14596 backend bck
14597 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
14598
14599 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
14600 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
14601 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
14602
14603 Field Format Extract from the example above
14604 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
14605 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
14606 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
14607 4 frontend_name fnt
14608 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
14609 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
14610 7 bytes_read* 212
14611 8 termination_state --
14612 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
14613 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
14614
14615Detailed fields description :
14616 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014617 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
14618 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
14619 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014620 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
14621 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
14622 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014623
14624 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014625 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
14626 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
14627 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014628
14629 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
14630 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
14631 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
14632 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
14633
14634 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
14635 and processed the connection.
14636
14637 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
14638 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
14639 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
14640 applications.
14641
14642 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
14643 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
14644 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
14645 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
14646 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
14647
14648 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
14649 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
14650 See "Timers" below for more details.
14651
14652 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
14653 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
14654 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
14655 "Timers" below for more details.
14656
14657 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014658 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014659 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
14660 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
14661 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
14662 details.
14663
14664 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
14665 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
14666 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
14667 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
14668 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
14669
14670 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
14671 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
14672 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
14673 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
14674 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
14675 for more details.
14676
14677 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014678 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014679 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
14680 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
14681 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014682 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014683
14684 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
14685 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
14686 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
14687 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
14688 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
14689 caused by a denial of service attack.
14690
14691 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
14692 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
14693 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
14694 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
14695 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
14696 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
14697 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
14698 denial of service attack.
14699
14700 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
14701 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
14702 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
14703 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
14704 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
14705 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
14706 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
14707 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
14708 be processed than on other servers.
14709
14710 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
14711 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
14712 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
14713 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
14714 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
14715 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
14716 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
14717 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
14718 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
14719 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
14720 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
14721 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
14722 should not be attributed to the logged server.
14723
14724 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
14725 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
14726 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
14727 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
14728 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
14729 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
14730 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
14731 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
14732
14733 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
14734 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
14735 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
14736 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
14737 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
14738 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
14739 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
14740 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
14741 occurs.
14742
14743
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200147448.2.3. HTTP log format
14745----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014746
14747The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
14748is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
14749the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
14750are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
14751emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
14752generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
14753"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
14754which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014755frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
14756is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014757
14758Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
14759slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
14760with a star ('*') after the field name below.
14761
14762 Example :
14763 frontend http-in
14764 mode http
14765 option httplog
14766 log global
14767 default_backend bck
14768
14769 backend static
14770 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
14771
14772 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
14773 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
14774 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014775 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014776
14777 Field Format Extract from the example above
14778 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
14779 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020014780 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014781 4 frontend_name http-in
14782 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020014783 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014784 7 status_code 200
14785 8 bytes_read* 2750
14786 9 captured_request_cookie -
14787 10 captured_response_cookie -
14788 11 termination_state ----
14789 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
14790 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
14791 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
14792 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
14793 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014794
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014795Detailed fields description :
14796 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014797 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
14798 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
14799 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014800 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
14801 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
14802 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014803
14804 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014805 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
14806 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
14807 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014808
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020014809 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
14810 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014811
14812 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
14813 and processed the connection.
14814
14815 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
14816 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
14817 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
14818
14819 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
14820 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
14821 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
14822 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
14823 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
14824 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
14825
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020014826 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
14827 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
14828 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
14829 request could be received or the a bad request was received. It should
14830 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
14831 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
14832 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014833
14834 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
14835 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
14836 See "Timers" below for more details.
14837
14838 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
14839 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
14840 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
14841 below for more details.
14842
14843 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
14844 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
14845 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
14846 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
14847 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
14848 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
14849 for more details.
14850
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020014851 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
14852 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
14853 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
14854 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
14855 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
14856 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
14857 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
14858 See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014859
14860 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
14861 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
14862 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
14863
14864 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
14865 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
14866 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
14867 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
14868 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
14869 overflowing.
14870
14871 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
14872 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
14873 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
14874 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
14875 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
14876 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
14877 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
14878 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
14879
14880 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
14881 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
14882 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
14883 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
14884 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
14885 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
14886 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
14887 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
14888
14889 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
14890 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
14891 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
14892 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
14893 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
14894 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
14895 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
14896
14897 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014898 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014899 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
14900 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
14901 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014902 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014903 system.
14904
14905 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
14906 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
14907 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
14908 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
14909 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
14910 caused by a denial of service attack.
14911
14912 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
14913 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
14914 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
14915 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
14916 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
14917 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
14918 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
14919 denial of service attack.
14920
14921 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
14922 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
14923 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
14924 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
14925 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
14926 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
14927 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
14928 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
14929 processed than on other servers.
14930
14931 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
14932 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
14933 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
14934 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
14935 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
14936 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
14937 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
14938 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
14939 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
14940 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
14941 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
14942 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
14943 should not be attributed to the logged server.
14944
14945 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
14946 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
14947 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
14948 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
14949 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
14950 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
14951 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
14952 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
14953
14954 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
14955 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
14956 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
14957 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
14958 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
14959 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
14960 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
14961 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
14962 occurs.
14963
14964 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
14965 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
14966 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
14967 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
14968 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
14969 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
14970 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
14971 cookies" below for more details.
14972
14973 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
14974 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
14975 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
14976 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
14977 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
14978 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
14979 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
14980 and cookies" below for more details.
14981
14982 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
14983 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
14984 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
14985 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
14986 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
14987 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
14988 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
14989 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
14990
14991
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200149928.2.4. Custom log format
14993------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014994
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014995The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014996mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014997
14998HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
14999Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
15000separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
15001prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
15002
15003Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
15004variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015005("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015006
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010015007If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020015008as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010015009less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
15010the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
15011
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015012Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015013In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010015014in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015015
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015016Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
15017'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
15018https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
15019such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
15020
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015021Flags are :
15022 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015023 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015024 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
15025 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015026
15027 Example:
15028
15029 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
15030 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
15031
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015032 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
15033
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015034At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
15035
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015036 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
15037 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015038
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015039the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015040
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015041 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
15042 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
15043 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015044
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015045and the default TCP format is defined this way :
15046
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015047 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
15048 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015049
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015050Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
15051
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015052 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015053 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015054 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
15055 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
15056 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015057 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
15058 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
15059 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015060 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000015061 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
15062 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000015063 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000015064 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
15065 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010015066 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020015067 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015068 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015069 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015070 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020015071 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080015072 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015073 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
15074 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
15075 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
15076 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
15077 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015078 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015079 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
15080 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015081 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015082 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
15083 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015084 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
15085 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
15086 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015087 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015088 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
15089 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015090 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015091 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
15092 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
15093 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020015094 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020015095 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020015096 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
15097 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
15098 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
15099 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020015100 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015101 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015102 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015103 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010015104 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015105 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015106 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
15107 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
15108 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015109 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015110 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
15111 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015112 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015113 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
15114 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
15115 | H | %trl | locla_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015116 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015117 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015118 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015119
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015120 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015121
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010015122
151238.2.5. Error log format
15124-----------------------
15125
15126When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
15127protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
15128By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
15129"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
15130will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
15131logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
15132
15133The format looks like this :
15134
15135 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
15136 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
15137 Connection error during SSL handshake
15138
15139 Field Format Extract from the example above
15140 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
15141 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
15142 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
15143 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
15144 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
15145
15146These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
15147failures.
15148
15149
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200151508.3. Advanced logging options
15151-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015152
15153Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
15154just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
15155options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
15156for more information about their usage.
15157
15158
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200151598.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
15160------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015161
15162It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
15163haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
15164commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
15165monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
15166ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
15167
15168 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
15169 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
15170 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
15171 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
15172
15173 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
15174 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
15175 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015176 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015177 such as other load-balancers.
15178
15179 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
15180 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
15181 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
15182
15183
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200151848.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
15185----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015186
15187The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
15188what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
15189or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
15190"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
15191just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
15192log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
15193after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
15194is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
15195with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
15196with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
15197
15198
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200151998.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
15200------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015201
15202Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
15203for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
15204"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
15205retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
15206raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
15207a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
15208file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
15209you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
15210"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
15211
15212
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152138.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
15214--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015215
15216Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
15217multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
15218them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
15219"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
15220logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
15221error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
15222and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
15223too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
15224useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
15225alternative.
15226
15227
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152288.4. Timing events
15229------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015230
15231Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
15232reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
15233the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
15234frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015235mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
15236addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
15237
15238 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
15239 protocols. Currently, these protocoles are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
15240 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
15241 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
15242 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
15243 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (eg: MTU issues), or that an
15244 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015245
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015246 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
15247 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
15248 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
15249 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. Some
15250 browsers pre-establish connections to a server in order to reduce the
15251 latency of a future request, and keep them pending until they need it. This
15252 delay will be reported as the idle time. A value of -1 indicates that
15253 nothing was received on the connection.
15254
15255 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
15256 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
15257 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
15258 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
15259 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
15260 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
15261 request typed by hand during a test.
15262
15263 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
15264 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
15265 exactly equalt to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
15266 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
15267 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
15268 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
15269 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015270
15271 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
15272 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
15273 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
15274 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
15275 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
15276
15277 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
15278 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
15279 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
15280 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
15281 connection never established.
15282
15283 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
15284 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
15285 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
15286 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
15287 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
15288 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
15289 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
15290 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
15291 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
15292 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
15293 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
15294
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015295 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
15296 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
15297 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
15298 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
15299 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
15300 by subtracting other timers when valid :
15301
15302 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
15303
15304 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
15305 "Ta" can never be negative.
15306
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015307 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
15308 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015309 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
15310 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015311 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015312
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015313 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015314
15315 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015316 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
15317 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015318
15319These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
15320protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
15321that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015322due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
15323"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
15324that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015325
15326Most common cases :
15327
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015328 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
15329 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
15330 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
15331 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
15332 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
15333 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
15334 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
15335 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
15336 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
15337 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
15338 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020015339 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015340
15341 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
15342 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
15343 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
15344 of ms on remote networks.
15345
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015346 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
15347 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
15348 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015349
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015350 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
15351 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
15352 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
15353 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
15354 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
15355 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
15356 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
15357 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
15358 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015359
15360Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
15361
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015362 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015363 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015364 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015365
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015366 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015367 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
15368 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
15369
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015370 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015371 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
15372 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
15373 flags.
15374
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015375 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
15376 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015377 Check the session termination flags, then check the
15378 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
15379 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
15380 the client connection was maintained open.
15381
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015382 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015383 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015384 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015385 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
15386
15387
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200153888.5. Session state at disconnection
15389-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015390
15391TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
15392"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
153932-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
15394each of which has a special meaning :
15395
15396 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
15397 session to terminate :
15398
15399 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
15400
15401 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
15402 server explicitly refused it.
15403
15404 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
15405 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
15406 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
15407 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020015408 (eg: cacheable cookie).
15409
15410 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
15411 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015412
15413 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
15414 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
15415 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
15416 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
15417 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
15418
15419 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
15420 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
15421 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
15422 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
15423 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
15424
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090015425 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
15426 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
15427
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070015428 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
15429 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
15430 backup connections when going up.
15431
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020015432 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
15433
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015434 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
15435 send or receive data.
15436
15437 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
15438 send or receive data.
15439
15440 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
15441 with nothing left in the buffers.
15442
15443 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
15444
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010015445 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015446 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
15447
15448 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
15449 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
15450 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
15451 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
15452 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
15453
15454 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
15455 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
15456
15457 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
15458 server (HTTP only).
15459
15460 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
15461
15462 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
15463 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
15464 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
15465
15466 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
15467 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
15468 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
15469
15470 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
15471
15472 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
15473 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
15474
15475 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
15476 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
15477 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
15478
15479 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
15480 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020015481 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
15482 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015483
15484 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
15485 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
15486 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
15487 another server.
15488
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015489 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015490 server.
15491
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015492 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
15493 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
15494 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
15495 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
15496
15497 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
15498 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
15499 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
15500 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
15501
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020015502 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
15503 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
15504 "use-server" rule).
15505
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015506 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
15507
15508 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
15509 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
15510
15511 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
15512
15513 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
15514 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
15515 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
15516
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015517 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
15518 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015519 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015520 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
15521 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
15522
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015523 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
15524
15525 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
15526 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
15527
15528 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
15529
15530 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
15531
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015532The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
15533was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015534helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
15535starvation, attacks, etc...
15536
15537The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
15538alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
15539easier finding and understanding.
15540
15541 Flags Reason
15542
15543 -- Normal termination.
15544
15545 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
15546 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
15547 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
15548 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
15549
15550 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
15551 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
15552 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
15553 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
15554 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
15555 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015556
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015557 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
15558 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020015559 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015560
15561 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
15562 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
15563 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
15564
15565 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
15566 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
15567 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
15568 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
15569 the server takes too long to respond.
15570
15571 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
15572 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
15573 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
15574 long a time to respond.
15575
15576 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
15577 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
15578 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
15579 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020015580 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
15581 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015582
15583 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
15584 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
15585 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
15586 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
15587 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020015588 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020015589 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
15590 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
15591 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
15592 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
15593 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
15594 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
15595 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
15596 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
15597 around the undesirable effects of this behaviour by adding "option
15598 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
15599 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
15600 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015601
15602 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
15603 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015604 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
15605 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
15606 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
15607 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015608
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020015609 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
15610 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
15611
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015612 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015613 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
15614 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
15615 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
15616 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
15617 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
15618
15619 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
15620 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
15621 503 or 504 here.
15622
15623 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
15624 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
15625 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
15626 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
15627 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
15628
15629 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
15630 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015631 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015632 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
15633 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
15634
15635 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
15636 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
15637 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
15638 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
15639 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
15640 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
15641 between haproxy and the server.
15642
15643 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
15644 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
15645 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
15646 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
15647 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
15648 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
15649 solution is to fix the application.
15650
15651 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
15652 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
15653 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
15654 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
15655 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
15656 external attacks.
15657
15658 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
15659 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020015660 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015661 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
15662 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
15663
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010015664 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
15665 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
15666 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020015667 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
15668 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010015669
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015670 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
15671 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
15672 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
15673 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010015674 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
15675 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
15676 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
15677 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
15678 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015679
15680 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
15681 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
15682 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
15683 returned an HTTP 403 error.
15684
15685 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
15686 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
15687 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
15688 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
15689
15690 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
15691 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
15692 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
15693 only be solved by proper system tuning.
15694
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015695The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
15696persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
15697important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
15698re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
15699
15700 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
15701
15702 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
15703 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
15704 set on a GET request.
15705
15706 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
15707 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015708 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015709 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
15710
15711 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
15712 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
15713 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
15714
15715 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
15716 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
15717 already got a cookie.
15718
15719 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
15720 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
15721 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
15722 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
15723 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
15724
15725 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
15726 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
15727 new cookie was inserted in the response.
15728
15729 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
15730 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
15731 new cookie was inserted in the response.
15732
15733 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
15734 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
15735
15736 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
15737 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
15738 then advertised in the response.
15739
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015740
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157418.6. Non-printable characters
15742-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015743
15744In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
15745consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
15746converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
15747prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
15748being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
15749escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
15750is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
15751'}' when logging headers.
15752
15753Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
15754issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
15755containing spaces is "User-Agent".
15756
15757Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
15758the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
15759performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
15760
15761
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157628.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
15763---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015764
15765Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
15766achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015767section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015768cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
15769the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
15770the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015771locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015772not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
15773user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
15774a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
15775wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
15776
15777 Examples :
15778 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
15779 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
15780
15781 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
15782 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
15783
15784
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157858.8. Capturing HTTP headers
15786---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015787
15788Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
15789proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
15790the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
15791server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
15792
15793Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
15794response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015795section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015796
15797It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015798time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
15799appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015800are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
15801and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
15802follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
15803request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
15804in the logs.
15805
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020015806As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
15807frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
15808an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
15809
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015810 Example :
15811 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
15812 listen proxy-out
15813 mode http
15814 option httplog
15815 option logasap
15816 log global
15817 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
15818
15819 # log the name of the virtual server
15820 capture request header Host len 20
15821
15822 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
15823 capture request header Content-Length len 10
15824
15825 # log the beginning of the referrer
15826 capture request header Referer len 20
15827
15828 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
15829 capture response header Server len 20
15830
15831 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
15832 capture response header Content-Length len 10
15833
15834 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
15835 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
15836
15837 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
15838 capture response header Via len 20
15839
15840 # log the URL location during a redirection
15841 capture response header Location len 20
15842
15843 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
15844 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
15845 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
15846 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
15847 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
15848
15849 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
15850 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
15851 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
15852 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015853 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015854
15855 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
15856 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
15857 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
15858 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
15859 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015860 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015861
15862
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158638.9. Examples of logs
15864---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015865
15866These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
15867them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
15868reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
15869
15870 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
15871 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
15872 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
15873
15874 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
15875 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
15876
15877 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
15878 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
15879 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
15880
15881 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
15882 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
15883
15884 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
15885 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
15886 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
15887
15888 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015889 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015890 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
15891 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
15892
15893 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
15894 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
15895 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
15896
15897 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
15898 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020015899 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015900 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
15901 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
15902 to return the 502 and not the server.
15903
15904 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015905 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015906
15907 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
15908 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
15909 Nothing was sent to any server.
15910
15911 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
15912 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
15913
15914 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
15915 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
15916 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
15917 send a 408 return code to the client.
15918
15919 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
15920 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
15921
15922 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
15923 5 seconds ("c----").
15924
15925 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
15926 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015927 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015928
15929 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015930 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015931 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
15932 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
15933 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
15934 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
15935 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010015936
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020015937
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200159389. Supported filters
15939--------------------
15940
15941Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
15942accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
15943unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
15944
15945See also : "filter"
15946
159479.1. Trace
15948----------
15949
15950filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding]
15951
15952 Arguments:
15953 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
15954 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
15955
15956 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
15957 the client and the server. By default, this filter
15958 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
15959 only parses a random amount of the available data.
15960
15961 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwading of parsed data. By
15962 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
15963 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
15964 amount of the parsed data.
15965
15966This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
15967callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
15968information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
15969filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
15970
15971Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
15972tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
15973a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
15974
15975
159769.2. HTTP compression
15977---------------------
15978
15979filter compression
15980
15981The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
15982keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
15983when no other filter is used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly
15984use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when two or more filters are
15985used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the
15986filters evaluation order.
15987
15988See also : "compression"
15989
15990
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015991/*
15992 * Local variables:
15993 * fill-column: 79
15994 * End:
15995 */